* alloc.c (Fgarbage_collect): Unblock input after clearing
[bpt/emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
22
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <stdio.h>
25
26 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
27
28 #include "lisp.h"
29 #include "blockinput.h"
30 #include "syssignal.h"
31
32 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
33 if this is not done before the other system files. */
34 #include "xterm.h"
35 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
36
37 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
38 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
39 #ifndef makedev
40 #include <sys/types.h>
41 #endif /* makedev */
42
43 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
44
45 #include "systime.h"
46
47 #include <fcntl.h>
48 #include <errno.h>
49 #include <sys/stat.h>
50 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
51 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
52
53 #include "charset.h"
54 #include "character.h"
55 #include "coding.h"
56 #include "frame.h"
57 #include "dispextern.h"
58 #include "fontset.h"
59 #include "termhooks.h"
60 #include "termopts.h"
61 #include "termchar.h"
62 #include "emacs-icon.h"
63 #include "disptab.h"
64 #include "buffer.h"
65 #include "window.h"
66 #include "keyboard.h"
67 #include "intervals.h"
68 #include "process.h"
69 #include "atimer.h"
70 #include "keymap.h"
71 #include "font.h"
72 #include "fontset.h"
73 #include "xsettings.h"
74 #include "xgselect.h"
75 #include "sysselect.h"
76
77 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
78 #include <X11/Shell.h>
79 #endif
80
81 #include <unistd.h>
82
83 #ifdef USE_GTK
84 #include "gtkutil.h"
85 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
86 #include <X11/Xproto.h>
87 #endif
88 #endif
89
90 #ifdef USE_LUCID
91 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
92 #endif
93
94 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
95 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
96 #define HACK_EDITRES
97 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget, XtPointer, XEvent *, Boolean *);
98 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
99
100 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
101
102 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
103 #if defined USE_MOTIF
104 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
105 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
106 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
107
108 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
109 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
110 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
111 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
112 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
113 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
114 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
115 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
116 #ifndef XtNpickTop
117 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
118 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
119 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
120 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
121
122 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
123
124 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
125 #include "widget.h"
126 #ifndef XtNinitialState
127 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
128 #endif
129 #endif
130
131 #include "bitmaps/gray.xbm"
132
133 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
134 #ifdef USE_XIM
135 int use_xim = 1;
136 #else
137 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
138 #endif
139
140 \f
141
142 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
143 start. */
144
145 static int any_help_event_p;
146
147 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
148 static Lisp_Object last_window;
149
150 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
151 use. */
152
153 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
154
155 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
156 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
157 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
158 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
159
160 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
161
162 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
163
164 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
165
166 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
167
168 static struct {
169 struct frame *f;
170 int eventtype;
171 } pending_event_wait;
172
173 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
174 /* The application context for Xt use. */
175 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
176 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
177
178 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
179
180 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
181 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
182
183 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
184 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
185 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
186
187 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
188
189 /* Mouse movement.
190
191 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
192 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
193 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
194 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
195
196 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
197
198 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
199 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
200 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
201 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
202 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
203 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
204 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
205 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
206 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
207 is off. */
208
209 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
210
211 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
212 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
213 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
214
215 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
216
217 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
218 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
219 an ordinary motion.
220
221 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
222 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
223 event. */
224
225 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
226
227 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
228 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
229 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
230 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
231 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
232 it's somewhat accurate. */
233
234 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
235
236 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
237
238 static Time last_user_time;
239
240 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
241 events. */
242
243 static int volatile input_signal_count;
244
245 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
246
247 static int x_noop_count;
248
249 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
250
251 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
252 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
253
254 #ifdef USE_GTK
255 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
256 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
257
258 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
259 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
260 #endif
261
262 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
263 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
264
265 enum xembed_info
266 {
267 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
268 };
269
270 enum xembed_message
271 {
272 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
273 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
274 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
275 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
276 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
277 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
278 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
279 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
280
281 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
282 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
283 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
284 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
285 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
286 };
287
288 /* Used in x_flush. */
289
290 static bool x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
291 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
292 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame *);
293 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame *);
294 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
295 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
296
297 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
298 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
299 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
300 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
301 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
302 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
303 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
304 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
305 static _Noreturn void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *, int, int);
306 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
307 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
308 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
309 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
310 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
311 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
312 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
313 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
314 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
315 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
316 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
317 enum text_cursor_kinds);
318
319 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
320 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
321 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
322 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
323 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
324 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
325 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
326 enum scroll_bar_part *,
327 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
328 Time *);
329 static int x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
330 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
331 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
332 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
333 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
334 int *, struct input_event *);
335 #ifdef USE_GTK
336 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent *, Display *);
337 #endif
338 /* Don't declare this _Noreturn because we want no
339 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
340 static void x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
341 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *, int);
342 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *, ptrdiff_t);
343 static void x_initialize (void);
344
345
346 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
347
348 static void
349 x_flush (struct frame *f)
350 {
351 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
352 connection may be broken. */
353 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
354 return;
355
356 block_input ();
357 if (f == NULL)
358 {
359 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
360 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
361 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
362 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
363 }
364 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
365 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
366 unblock_input ();
367 }
368
369
370 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
371 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
372 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
373 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
374 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
375 performance. */
376
377 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
378
379 \f
380 /***********************************************************************
381 Debugging
382 ***********************************************************************/
383
384 #if 0
385
386 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
387 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
388
389 struct record
390 {
391 char *locus;
392 int type;
393 };
394
395 struct record event_record[100];
396
397 int event_record_index;
398
399 void
400 record_event (char *locus, int type)
401 {
402 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
403 event_record_index = 0;
404
405 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
406 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
407 event_record_index++;
408 }
409
410 #endif /* 0 */
411
412
413 \f
414 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
415
416 struct x_display_info *
417 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
418 {
419 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
420
421 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
422 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
423 return dpyinfo;
424
425 return 0;
426 }
427
428 static Window
429 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame *f)
430 {
431 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
432 Window win = None, wi = x->parent_desc;
433 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
434
435 while (wi != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
436 {
437 Window root;
438 Window *children;
439 unsigned int nchildren;
440
441 win = wi;
442 XQueryTree (dpy, win, &root, &wi, &children, &nchildren);
443 XFree (children);
444 }
445
446 return win;
447 }
448
449 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
450
451 void
452 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
453 {
454 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
455 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
456 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
457 double alpha = 1.0;
458 double alpha_min = 1.0;
459 unsigned long opac;
460 Window parent;
461
462 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
463 alpha = f->alpha[0];
464 else
465 alpha = f->alpha[1];
466
467 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
468 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
469 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
470 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
471
472 if (alpha < 0.0)
473 return;
474 else if (alpha > 1.0)
475 alpha = 1.0;
476 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
477 alpha = alpha_min;
478
479 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
480
481 x_catch_errors (dpy);
482
483 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
484 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
485 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
486 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
487
488 parent = x_find_topmost_parent (f);
489 if (parent != None)
490 XChangeProperty (dpy, parent, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
491 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
492 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
493
494 /* return unless necessary */
495 {
496 unsigned char *data;
497 Atom actual;
498 int rc, format;
499 unsigned long n, left;
500
501 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
502 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
503 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
504 &data);
505
506 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
507 {
508 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
509 XFree (data);
510 if (value == opac)
511 {
512 x_uncatch_errors ();
513 return;
514 }
515 }
516 }
517
518 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
519 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
520 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
521 x_uncatch_errors ();
522 }
523
524 int
525 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
526 {
527 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
528 }
529
530 int
531 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
532 {
533 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
534 }
535
536 \f
537 /***********************************************************************
538 Starting and ending an update
539 ***********************************************************************/
540
541 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
542 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
543 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
544 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
545 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
546
547 static void
548 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
549 {
550 /* Nothing to do. */
551 }
552
553
554 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
555 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
556 position of W. */
557
558 static void
559 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
560 {
561 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
562 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
563
564 updated_window = w;
565 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
566
567 block_input ();
568
569 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
570 {
571 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
572 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
573
574 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
575 highlighting. */
576 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
577 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
578 }
579
580 unblock_input ();
581 }
582
583
584 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
585
586 static void
587 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
588 {
589 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
590 struct face *face;
591
592 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
593 if (face)
594 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
595 face->foreground);
596
597 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
598 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
599 }
600
601 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
602
603 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
604 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
605
606 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
607 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
608 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
609
610 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
611 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
612 here. */
613
614 static void
615 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
616 {
617 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
618
619 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
620 {
621 block_input ();
622
623 if (cursor_on_p)
624 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
625 output_cursor.vpos,
626 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
627
628 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
629 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
630
631 unblock_input ();
632 }
633
634 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
635 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
636 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
637 {
638 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
639 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
640 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
641 }
642
643 updated_window = NULL;
644 }
645
646
647 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
648 update_end. */
649
650 static void
651 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
652 {
653 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
654 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
655
656 #ifndef XFlush
657 block_input ();
658 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
659 unblock_input ();
660 #endif
661 }
662
663
664 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
665 complete update has been performed. The global variable
666 updated_window is not available here. */
667
668 static void
669 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
670 {
671 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
672 FRAME_MOUSE_UPDATE (f);
673 }
674
675
676 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
677 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
678 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
679 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
680 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
681 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
682
683 static void
684 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
685 {
686 struct window *w = updated_window;
687 struct frame *f;
688 int width, height;
689
690 eassert (w);
691
692 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
693 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
694
695 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
696 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
697 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
698 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
699 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
700 overhead is very small. */
701 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
702 && desired_row->full_width_p
703 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
704 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
705 width != 0)
706 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
707 height > 0))
708 {
709 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
710
711 block_input ();
712 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
713 0, y, width, height, False);
714 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
715 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
716 y, width, height, False);
717 unblock_input ();
718 }
719 }
720
721 static void
722 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
723 {
724 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
725 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
726 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
727 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
728 struct face *face = p->face;
729
730 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
731 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
732
733 if (!p->overlay_p)
734 {
735 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
736
737 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
738 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
739 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
740 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
741 if (face->stipple)
742 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
743 else
744 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
745
746 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
747 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
748 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
749 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
750 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
751 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
752 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
753 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
754 {
755 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
756
757 if (sb_width > 0)
758 {
759 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
760 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
761 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
762
763 if (bx < 0)
764 {
765 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
766 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == p->x)
767 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
768 else if (p->x + p->wd == bar_area_x)
769 bx = bar_area_x;
770 if (bx >= 0)
771 {
772 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
773
774 nx = bar_area_width - sb_width;
775 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
776 row->y));
777 ny = row->visible_height;
778 }
779 }
780 else
781 {
782 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == bx)
783 {
784 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
785 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
786 }
787 else if (bx + nx == bar_area_x)
788 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
789 }
790 }
791 }
792 #endif
793 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
794 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
795
796 if (!face->stipple)
797 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
798 }
799
800 if (p->which)
801 {
802 char *bits;
803 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
804 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
805 XGCValues gcv;
806
807 if (p->wd > 8)
808 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
809 else
810 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
811
812 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
813 by the server. */
814 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
815 (p->cursor_p
816 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
817 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
818 : face->foreground),
819 face->background, depth);
820
821 if (p->overlay_p)
822 {
823 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
824 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
825 bits, p->wd, p->h,
826 1, 0, 1);
827 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
828 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
829 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
830 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
831 }
832
833 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
834 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
835 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
836
837 if (p->overlay_p)
838 {
839 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
840 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
841 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
842 }
843 }
844
845 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
846 }
847
848 \f
849
850 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
851 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
852 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
853 rarely happens). */
854
855 static void
856 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
857 {
858 }
859
860 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
861 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
862
863 static void
864 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
865 {
866 }
867
868 \f
869 /***********************************************************************
870 Glyph display
871 ***********************************************************************/
872
873
874
875 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
876 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
877 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
878 int);
879 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
880 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
881 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
882 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
883 static _Noreturn void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int);
884 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
885 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
886 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
887 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
888 static bool x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
889 unsigned long *, double, int);
890 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
891 double, int, unsigned long);
892 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
893 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
894 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
895 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
896 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
897 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
898 int, int, int);
899 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
900 int, int, int, int, int, int,
901 XRectangle *);
902 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
903 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
904 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
905
906 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
907 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
908 #endif
909
910
911 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
912 face. */
913
914 static void
915 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
916 {
917 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
918 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
919 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
920 && !s->cmp)
921 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
922 else
923 {
924 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
925 XGCValues xgcv;
926 unsigned long mask;
927
928 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
929 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
930
931 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
932 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
933 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
934 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
935 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
936 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
937 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
938
939 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
940 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
941 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
942 {
943 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
944 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
945 }
946
947 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
948 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
949 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
950
951 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
952 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
953 mask, &xgcv);
954 else
955 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
956 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
957
958 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
959 }
960 }
961
962
963 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
964
965 static void
966 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
967 {
968 int face_id;
969 struct face *face;
970
971 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
972 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
973 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
974 if (face == NULL)
975 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
976
977 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
978 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
979 else
980 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
981 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
982 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
983
984 if (s->font == s->face->font)
985 s->gc = s->face->gc;
986 else
987 {
988 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
989 except for FONT. */
990 XGCValues xgcv;
991 unsigned long mask;
992
993 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
994 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
995 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
996 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
997
998 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
999 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1000 mask, &xgcv);
1001 else
1002 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1003 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1004
1005 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1006
1007 }
1008 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1009 }
1010
1011
1012 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1013 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1014 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1015
1016 static void
1017 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1018 {
1019 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1020 }
1021
1022
1023 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1024 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1025 pattern. */
1026
1027 static void
1028 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1029 {
1030 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1031
1032 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1033 {
1034 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1035 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1036 }
1037 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1038 {
1039 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1040 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1041 }
1042 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1043 {
1044 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1045 s->stippled_p = 0;
1046 }
1047 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1048 {
1049 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1050 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1051 }
1052 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1053 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1054 {
1055 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1056 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1057 }
1058 else
1059 {
1060 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1061 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1062 }
1063
1064 /* GC must have been set. */
1065 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1066 }
1067
1068
1069 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1070 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1071
1072 static void
1073 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1074 {
1075 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1076 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1077
1078 if (n > 0)
1079 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1080 s->num_clips = n;
1081 }
1082
1083
1084 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1085 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1086 the area of SRC. */
1087
1088 static void
1089 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1090 {
1091 XRectangle r;
1092
1093 r.x = src->x;
1094 r.width = src->width;
1095 r.y = src->y;
1096 r.height = src->height;
1097 dst->clip[0] = r;
1098 dst->num_clips = 1;
1099 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1100 }
1101
1102
1103 /* RIF:
1104 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1105
1106 static void
1107 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1108 {
1109 if (s->cmp == NULL
1110 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1111 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1112 {
1113 struct font_metrics metrics;
1114
1115 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1116 {
1117 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1118 struct font *font = s->font;
1119 int i;
1120
1121 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1122 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1123 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1124 }
1125 else
1126 {
1127 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1128
1129 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1130 }
1131 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1132 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1133 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1134 }
1135 else if (s->cmp)
1136 {
1137 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1138 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1139 }
1140 }
1141
1142
1143 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1144
1145 static void
1146 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1147 {
1148 XGCValues xgcv;
1149 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1150 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1151 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1152 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1153 }
1154
1155
1156 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1157 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1158 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1159 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1160 contains the first component of a composition. */
1161
1162 static void
1163 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1164 {
1165 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1166 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1167 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1168 {
1169 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1170
1171 if (s->stippled_p)
1172 {
1173 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1174 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1175 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1176 s->y + box_line_width,
1177 s->background_width,
1178 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1179 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1180 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1181 }
1182 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1183 || s->font_not_found_p
1184 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1185 || force_p)
1186 {
1187 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1188 s->background_width,
1189 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1190 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1191 }
1192 }
1193 }
1194
1195
1196 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1197
1198 static void
1199 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1200 {
1201 int i, x;
1202
1203 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1204 of S to the right of that box line. */
1205 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1206 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1207 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1208 else
1209 x = s->x;
1210
1211 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1212 loaded. */
1213 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1214 {
1215 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1216 {
1217 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1218 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1219 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1220 s->height - 1);
1221 x += g->pixel_width;
1222 }
1223 }
1224 else
1225 {
1226 struct font *font = s->font;
1227 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1228 int y;
1229
1230 if (font->vertical_centering)
1231 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1232
1233 y = s->ybase - boff;
1234 if (s->for_overlaps
1235 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1236 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1237 else
1238 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1239 if (s->face->overstrike)
1240 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1241 }
1242 }
1243
1244 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1245
1246 static void
1247 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1248 {
1249 int i, j, x;
1250 struct font *font = s->font;
1251
1252 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1253 of S to the right of that box line. */
1254 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1255 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1256 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1257 else
1258 x = s->x;
1259
1260 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1261 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1262 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1263 this composition. */
1264
1265 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1266 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1267 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1268 {
1269 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1270 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1271 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1272 }
1273 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1274 {
1275 int y = s->ybase;
1276
1277 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1278 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1279 space on the left or right. */
1280 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1281 {
1282 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1283 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1284
1285 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1286 if (s->face->overstrike)
1287 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1288 }
1289 }
1290 else
1291 {
1292 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1293 Lisp_Object glyph;
1294 int y = s->ybase;
1295 int width = 0;
1296
1297 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1298 {
1299 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1300 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1301 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1302 else
1303 {
1304 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1305
1306 if (j < i)
1307 {
1308 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1309 if (s->face->overstrike)
1310 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1311 x += width;
1312 }
1313 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1314 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1315 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1316 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1317 if (s->face->overstrike)
1318 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1319 x += wadjust;
1320 j = i + 1;
1321 width = 0;
1322 }
1323 }
1324 if (j < i)
1325 {
1326 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1327 if (s->face->overstrike)
1328 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1329 }
1330 }
1331 }
1332
1333
1334 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1335
1336 static void
1337 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1338 {
1339 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1340 XChar2b char2b[8];
1341 int x, i, j;
1342
1343 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1344 of S to the right of that box line. */
1345 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1346 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1347 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1348 else
1349 x = s->x;
1350
1351 s->char2b = char2b;
1352
1353 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1354 {
1355 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1356 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1357
1358 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1359 {
1360 if (len > 0
1361 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1362 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1363 >= 1))
1364 {
1365 Lisp_Object acronym
1366 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1367 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1368 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1369 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1370 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1371 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1372 }
1373 }
1374 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1375 {
1376 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1377 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1378 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1379 str = buf;
1380 }
1381
1382 if (str)
1383 {
1384 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1385 unsigned code;
1386
1387 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1388 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1389 {
1390 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1391 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1392 }
1393 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1394 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1395 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1396 0);
1397 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1398 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1399 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1400 0);
1401 }
1402 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1403 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1404 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1405 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1406 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1407 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1408 }
1409 }
1410
1411 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1412
1413 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1414 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1415 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1416 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1417
1418 #ifdef USE_LUCID
1419
1420 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1421 cannot be determined. */
1422
1423 static struct frame *
1424 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1425 {
1426 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1427 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
1428 struct frame *f;
1429
1430 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1431
1432 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1433 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1434 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1435 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1436 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1437 widget = XtParent (widget);
1438
1439 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1440 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1441 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
1442 {
1443 f = XFRAME (frame);
1444 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
1445 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1446 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo
1447 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1448 return f;
1449 }
1450 emacs_abort ();
1451 }
1452
1453 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1454 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1455 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1456 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1457 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1458 Value is true if successful. */
1459
1460 bool
1461 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1462 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1463 {
1464 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1465 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1466 }
1467
1468 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
1469
1470
1471 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1472 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1473
1474 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1475 {
1476 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1477 sizeof (Screen *)},
1478 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1479 sizeof (Colormap)}
1480 };
1481
1482
1483 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1484 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1485
1486 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1487
1488
1489 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1490
1491 DPY is the display we are working on.
1492
1493 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1494 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1495 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1496 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1497
1498 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1499 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1500
1501 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1502 we allocated the color or not.
1503
1504 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1505
1506 static Boolean
1507 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1508 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1509 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1510 {
1511 Screen *screen;
1512 Colormap cmap;
1513 Pixel pixel;
1514 String color_name;
1515 XColor color;
1516
1517 if (*nargs != 2)
1518 {
1519 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1520 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1521 "XtToolkitError",
1522 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1523 return False;
1524 }
1525
1526 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1527 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1528 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1529
1530 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1531 {
1532 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1533 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1534 }
1535 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1536 {
1537 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1538 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1539 }
1540 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1541 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1542 {
1543 pixel = color.pixel;
1544 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1545 }
1546 else
1547 {
1548 String params[1];
1549 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1550
1551 params[0] = color_name;
1552 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1553 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1554 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1555 params, &nparams);
1556 return False;
1557 }
1558
1559 if (to->addr != NULL)
1560 {
1561 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1562 {
1563 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1564 return False;
1565 }
1566
1567 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1568 }
1569 else
1570 {
1571 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1572 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1573 }
1574
1575 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1576 return True;
1577 }
1578
1579
1580 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1581 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1582 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1583
1584 APP is the application context in which we work.
1585
1586 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1587 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1588 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1589
1590 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1591
1592 static void
1593 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1594 Cardinal *nargs)
1595 {
1596 if (*nargs != 2)
1597 {
1598 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1599 "XtToolkitError",
1600 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1601 NULL, NULL);
1602 }
1603 else if (closure != NULL)
1604 {
1605 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1606 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1607 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1608 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1609 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1610 }
1611 }
1612
1613
1614 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1615
1616
1617 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1618 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1619 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1620 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1621
1622 static const XColor *
1623 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1624 {
1625 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1626
1627 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1628 {
1629 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1630 int ncolor_cells = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1631 int i;
1632
1633 dpyinfo->color_cells = xnmalloc (ncolor_cells,
1634 sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1635 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = ncolor_cells;
1636
1637 for (i = 0; i < ncolor_cells; ++i)
1638 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1639
1640 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1641 dpyinfo->color_cells, ncolor_cells);
1642 }
1643
1644 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1645 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1646 }
1647
1648
1649 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1650 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1651
1652 void
1653 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1654 {
1655 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1656
1657 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1658 {
1659 int i;
1660 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1661 {
1662 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1663 eassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1664 eassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1665 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1666 }
1667 }
1668 else
1669 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1670 }
1671
1672
1673 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1674 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1675
1676 void
1677 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1678 {
1679 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1680 }
1681
1682
1683 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1684 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1685 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1686 allocated. */
1687
1688 static bool
1689 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1690 {
1691 bool rc;
1692
1693 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color) != 0;
1694 if (rc == 0)
1695 {
1696 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1697 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1698 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1699 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1700 int nearest, i;
1701 int max_color_delta = 255;
1702 int max_delta = 3 * max_color_delta;
1703 int nearest_delta = max_delta + 1;
1704 int ncells;
1705 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1706
1707 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1708 {
1709 int dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1710 int dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1711 int dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1712 int delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1713
1714 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1715 {
1716 nearest = i;
1717 nearest_delta = delta;
1718 }
1719 }
1720
1721 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1722 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1723 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1724 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color) != 0;
1725 }
1726 else
1727 {
1728 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1729 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1730 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1731 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1732 XColor *cached_color;
1733
1734 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1735 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1736 (cached_color->red != color->red
1737 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1738 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1739 {
1740 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1741 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1742 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1743 }
1744 }
1745
1746 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1747 if (rc)
1748 register_color (color->pixel);
1749 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1750
1751 return rc;
1752 }
1753
1754
1755 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1756 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1757 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1758 allocated. */
1759
1760 bool
1761 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1762 {
1763 gamma_correct (f, color);
1764 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1765 }
1766
1767
1768 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1769 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1770 get color reference counts right. */
1771
1772 unsigned long
1773 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1774 {
1775 XColor color;
1776
1777 color.pixel = pixel;
1778 block_input ();
1779 x_query_color (f, &color);
1780 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1781 unblock_input ();
1782 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1783 register_color (pixel);
1784 #endif
1785 return color.pixel;
1786 }
1787
1788
1789 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1790 boosted.
1791
1792 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1793 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1794 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1795 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1796 use an additional additive factor.
1797
1798 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1799 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1800 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1801
1802
1803 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1804 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1805 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1806 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1807 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1808 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1809
1810 static bool
1811 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1812 {
1813 XColor color, new;
1814 long bright;
1815 bool success_p;
1816
1817 /* Get RGB color values. */
1818 color.pixel = *pixel;
1819 x_query_color (f, &color);
1820
1821 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1822 eassert (factor >= 0);
1823 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1824 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1825 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1826
1827 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1828 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1829
1830 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1831 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1832 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1833 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1834 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1835 {
1836 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1837 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1838 /* The additive adjustment. */
1839 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1840
1841 if (factor < 1)
1842 {
1843 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1844 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1845 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1846 }
1847 else
1848 {
1849 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1850 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1851 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1852 }
1853 }
1854
1855 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1856 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1857 if (success_p)
1858 {
1859 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1860 {
1861 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1862 delta to the RGB values. */
1863 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1864
1865 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1866 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1867 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1868 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1869 }
1870 else
1871 success_p = 1;
1872 *pixel = new.pixel;
1873 }
1874
1875 return success_p;
1876 }
1877
1878
1879 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1880 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1881 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1882 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1883 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1884 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1885
1886 static void
1887 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1888 {
1889 XGCValues xgcv;
1890 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1891 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1892 unsigned long pixel;
1893 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1894 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1895 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1896 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1897
1898 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1899 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1900
1901 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1902 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1903 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1904 if (relief->gc
1905 && relief->allocated_p)
1906 {
1907 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1908 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1909 }
1910
1911 /* Allocate new color. */
1912 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1913 pixel = background;
1914 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1915 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1916 {
1917 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1918 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1919 }
1920
1921 if (relief->gc == 0)
1922 {
1923 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1924 mask |= GCStipple;
1925 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1926 }
1927 else
1928 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1929 }
1930
1931
1932 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1933
1934 static void
1935 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1936 {
1937 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1938 unsigned long color;
1939
1940 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1941 color = s->face->box_color;
1942 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1943 && s->img->pixmap
1944 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1945 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1946 else
1947 {
1948 XGCValues xgcv;
1949
1950 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1951 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1952 color = xgcv.background;
1953 }
1954
1955 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1956 || color != di->relief_background)
1957 {
1958 di->relief_background = color;
1959 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1960 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1961 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1962 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1963 }
1964 }
1965
1966
1967 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1968 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1969 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1970 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1971 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1972 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1973 when drawing. */
1974
1975 static void
1976 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
1977 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
1978 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
1979 XRectangle *clip_rect)
1980 {
1981 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1982 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
1983 int i;
1984 GC gc;
1985
1986 if (raised_p)
1987 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
1988 else
1989 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
1990 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
1991
1992 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
1993 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
1994 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
1995 corner pixels. */
1996
1997 /* Top. */
1998 if (top_p)
1999 {
2000 if (width == 1)
2001 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2002 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2003 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2004
2005 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2006 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2007 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2008 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2009 }
2010
2011 /* Left. */
2012 if (left_p)
2013 {
2014 if (width == 1)
2015 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2016
2017 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2018 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2019
2020 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2021 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2022 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2023 }
2024
2025 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2026 if (raised_p)
2027 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2028 else
2029 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2030 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2031
2032 if (width > 1)
2033 {
2034 /* Outermost top line. */
2035 if (top_p)
2036 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2037 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2038 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2039
2040 /* Outermost left line. */
2041 if (left_p)
2042 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2043 }
2044
2045 /* Bottom. */
2046 if (bot_p)
2047 {
2048 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2049 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2050 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2051 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2052 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2053 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2054 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2055 }
2056
2057 /* Right. */
2058 if (right_p)
2059 {
2060 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2061 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2062 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2063 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2064 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2065 }
2066
2067 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2068 }
2069
2070
2071 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2072 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2073 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2074 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2075 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2076 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2077
2078 static void
2079 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2080 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2081 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2082 {
2083 XGCValues xgcv;
2084
2085 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2086 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2087 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2088
2089 /* Top. */
2090 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2091 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2092
2093 /* Left. */
2094 if (left_p)
2095 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2096 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2097
2098 /* Bottom. */
2099 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2100 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2101
2102 /* Right. */
2103 if (right_p)
2104 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2105 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2106
2107 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2108 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2109 }
2110
2111
2112 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2113
2114 static void
2115 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2116 {
2117 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2118 int left_p, right_p;
2119 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2120 XRectangle clip_rect;
2121
2122 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2123 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2124 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2125
2126 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2127 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2128 ? s->first_glyph
2129 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2130
2131 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2132 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2133 left_x = s->x;
2134 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2135 ? last_x - 1
2136 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2137 top_y = s->y;
2138 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2139
2140 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2141 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2142 && (s->prev == NULL
2143 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2144 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2145 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2146 && (s->next == NULL
2147 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2148
2149 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2150
2151 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2152 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2153 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2154 else
2155 {
2156 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2157 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2158 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2159 }
2160 }
2161
2162
2163 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2164
2165 static void
2166 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2167 {
2168 int x = s->x;
2169 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2170
2171 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2172 right of that line. */
2173 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2174 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2175 && s->slice.x == 0)
2176 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2177
2178 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2179 by that margin. */
2180 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2181 x += s->img->hmargin;
2182 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2183 y += s->img->vmargin;
2184
2185 if (s->img->pixmap)
2186 {
2187 if (s->img->mask)
2188 {
2189 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2190 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2191 trust on the shape extension to be available
2192 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2193 manually. */
2194 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2195 | GCFunction);
2196 XGCValues xgcv;
2197 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2198
2199 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2200 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2201 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2202 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2203 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2204
2205 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2206 image_rect.x = x;
2207 image_rect.y = y;
2208 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2209 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2210 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2211 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2212 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2213 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2214 }
2215 else
2216 {
2217 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2218
2219 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2220 image_rect.x = x;
2221 image_rect.y = y;
2222 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2223 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2224 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2225 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2226 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2227 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2228
2229 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2230 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2231 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2232 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2233 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2234 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2235 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2236 {
2237 int relief = s->img->relief;
2238 if (relief < 0) relief = -relief;
2239 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2240 x - relief, y - relief,
2241 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2242 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2243 }
2244 }
2245 }
2246 else
2247 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2248 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2249 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2250 }
2251
2252
2253 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2254
2255 static void
2256 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2257 {
2258 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2259 int extra_x, extra_y;
2260 XRectangle r;
2261 int x = s->x;
2262 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2263
2264 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2265 right of that line. */
2266 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2267 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2268 && s->slice.x == 0)
2269 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2270
2271 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2272 by that margin. */
2273 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2274 x += s->img->hmargin;
2275 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2276 y += s->img->vmargin;
2277
2278 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2279 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2280 {
2281 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2282 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2283 }
2284 else
2285 {
2286 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2287 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2288 }
2289
2290 extra_x = extra_y = 0;
2291 if (s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID)
2292 {
2293 if (CONSP (Vtool_bar_button_margin)
2294 && INTEGERP (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
2295 && INTEGERP (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)))
2296 {
2297 extra_x = XINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
2298 extra_y = XINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
2299 }
2300 else if (INTEGERP (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
2301 extra_x = extra_y = XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
2302 }
2303
2304 x0 = x - thick - extra_x;
2305 y0 = y - thick - extra_y;
2306 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1 + extra_x;
2307 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1 + extra_y;
2308
2309 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2310 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2311 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2312 s->slice.y == 0,
2313 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2314 s->slice.x == 0,
2315 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2316 &r);
2317 }
2318
2319
2320 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2321
2322 static void
2323 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2324 {
2325 int x = 0;
2326 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2327
2328 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2329 right of that line. */
2330 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2331 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2332 && s->slice.x == 0)
2333 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2334
2335 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2336 by that margin. */
2337 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2338 x += s->img->hmargin;
2339 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2340 y += s->img->vmargin;
2341
2342 if (s->img->pixmap)
2343 {
2344 if (s->img->mask)
2345 {
2346 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2347 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2348 trust on the shape extension to be available
2349 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2350 manually. */
2351 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2352 | GCFunction);
2353 XGCValues xgcv;
2354
2355 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2356 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2357 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2358 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2359 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2360
2361 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2362 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2363 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2364 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2365 }
2366 else
2367 {
2368 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2369 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2370 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2371
2372 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2373 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2374 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2375 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2376 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2377 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2378 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2379 {
2380 int r = s->img->relief;
2381 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2382 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2383 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2384 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2385 }
2386 }
2387 }
2388 else
2389 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2390 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2391 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2392 }
2393
2394
2395 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2396 give the rectangle to draw. */
2397
2398 static void
2399 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2400 {
2401 if (s->stippled_p)
2402 {
2403 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2404 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2405 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2406 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2407 }
2408 else
2409 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2410 }
2411
2412
2413 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2414
2415 s->y
2416 s->x +-------------------------
2417 | s->face->box
2418 |
2419 | +-------------------------
2420 | | s->img->margin
2421 | |
2422 | | +-------------------
2423 | | | the image
2424
2425 */
2426
2427 static void
2428 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2429 {
2430 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2431 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2432 int height;
2433 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2434
2435 height = s->height;
2436 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2437 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2438 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2439 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2440
2441 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2442 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2443 flickering. */
2444 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2445 if (height > s->slice.height
2446 || s->img->hmargin
2447 || s->img->vmargin
2448 || s->img->mask
2449 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2450 || s->width != s->background_width)
2451 {
2452 if (s->img->mask)
2453 {
2454 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2455 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2456 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2457 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2458 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2459
2460 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2461 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2462 s->background_width,
2463 s->height, depth);
2464
2465 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2466 pixmap. */
2467 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2468
2469 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2470 if (s->stippled_p)
2471 {
2472 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2473 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2474 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2475 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2476 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2477 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2478 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2479 }
2480 else
2481 {
2482 XGCValues xgcv;
2483 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2484 &xgcv);
2485 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2486 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2487 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2488 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2489 }
2490 }
2491 else
2492 {
2493 int x = s->x;
2494 int y = s->y;
2495
2496 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2497 && s->slice.x == 0)
2498 x += box_line_hwidth;
2499
2500 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2501 y += box_line_vwidth;
2502
2503 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2504 }
2505
2506 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2507 }
2508
2509 /* Draw the foreground. */
2510 if (pixmap != None)
2511 {
2512 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2513 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2514 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2515 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2516 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2517 }
2518 else
2519 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2520
2521 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2522 if (s->img->relief
2523 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2524 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2525 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2526 }
2527
2528
2529 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2530
2531 static void
2532 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2533 {
2534 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2535
2536 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2537 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2538 {
2539 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2540 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2541 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2542 int x = s->x;
2543
2544 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2545 {
2546 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2547
2548 if (x < left_x)
2549 {
2550 background_width -= left_x - x;
2551 x = left_x;
2552 }
2553 }
2554 else
2555 {
2556 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2557 stretch glyph. */
2558 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2559
2560 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2561 background_width -= x - right_x;
2562 x += background_width;
2563 }
2564 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2565 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2566 x -= width;
2567
2568 /* Draw cursor. */
2569 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2570
2571 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2572 if (width < background_width)
2573 {
2574 int y = s->y;
2575 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2576 XRectangle r;
2577 GC gc;
2578
2579 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2580 x += width;
2581 else
2582 x = s->x;
2583 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2584 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2585 {
2586 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2587 gc = s->gc;
2588 }
2589 else
2590 gc = s->face->gc;
2591
2592 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2593 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2594
2595 if (s->face->stipple)
2596 {
2597 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2598 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2599 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2600 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2601 }
2602 else
2603 {
2604 XGCValues xgcv;
2605 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2606 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2607 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2608 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2609 }
2610 }
2611 }
2612 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2613 {
2614 int background_width = s->background_width;
2615 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2616
2617 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2618 except for header line and mode line. */
2619 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2620 {
2621 background_width -= left_x - x;
2622 x = left_x;
2623 }
2624 if (background_width > 0)
2625 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2626 }
2627
2628 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2629 }
2630
2631 /*
2632 Draw a wavy line under S. The wave fills wave_height pixels from y0.
2633
2634 x0 wave_length = 2
2635 --
2636 y0 * * * * *
2637 |* * * * * * * * *
2638 wave_height = 3 | * * * *
2639
2640 */
2641
2642 static void
2643 x_draw_underwave (struct glyph_string *s)
2644 {
2645 int wave_height = 2, wave_length = 3;
2646 int dx, dy, x0, y0, width, x1, y1, x2, y2, odd, xmax;
2647 XRectangle wave_clip, string_clip, final_clip;
2648
2649 dx = wave_length;
2650 dy = wave_height - 1;
2651 x0 = s->x;
2652 y0 = s->ybase + 1;
2653 width = s->width;
2654 xmax = x0 + width;
2655
2656 /* Find and set clipping rectangle */
2657
2658 wave_clip = (XRectangle){ x0, y0, width, wave_height };
2659 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &string_clip);
2660
2661 if (!x_intersect_rectangles (&wave_clip, &string_clip, &final_clip))
2662 return;
2663
2664 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &final_clip, 1, Unsorted);
2665
2666 /* Draw the waves */
2667
2668 x1 = x0 - (x0 % dx);
2669 x2 = x1 + dx;
2670 odd = (x1/dx) % 2;
2671 y1 = y2 = y0;
2672
2673 if (odd)
2674 y1 += dy;
2675 else
2676 y2 += dy;
2677
2678 if (INT_MAX - dx < xmax)
2679 emacs_abort ();
2680
2681 while (x1 <= xmax)
2682 {
2683 XDrawLine (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x1, y1, x2, y2);
2684 x1 = x2, y1 = y2;
2685 x2 += dx, y2 = y0 + odd*dy;
2686 odd = !odd;
2687 }
2688
2689 /* Restore previous clipping rectangle(s) */
2690 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, s->clip, s->num_clips, Unsorted);
2691 }
2692
2693
2694 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2695
2696 static void
2697 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2698 {
2699 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2700
2701 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2702 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2703 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2704 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2705 {
2706 int width;
2707 struct glyph_string *next;
2708
2709 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2710 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2711 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2712 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2713 {
2714 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2715 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2716 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2717 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2718 else
2719 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2720 next->num_clips = 0;
2721 }
2722 }
2723
2724 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2725 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2726
2727 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2728 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2729 if (!s->for_overlaps
2730 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2731 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2732 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2733
2734 {
2735 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2736 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2737 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2738 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2739 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2740 }
2741 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2742 && !s->clip_tail
2743 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2744 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2745 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2746 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2747 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2748 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2749 else
2750 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2751
2752 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2753 {
2754 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2755 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2756 break;
2757
2758 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2759 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2760 break;
2761
2762 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2763 if (s->for_overlaps)
2764 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2765 else
2766 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2767 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2768 break;
2769
2770 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2771 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2772 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2773 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2774 else
2775 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2776 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2777 break;
2778
2779 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2780 if (s->for_overlaps)
2781 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2782 else
2783 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2784 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2785 break;
2786
2787 default:
2788 emacs_abort ();
2789 }
2790
2791 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2792 {
2793 /* Draw underline. */
2794 if (s->face->underline_p)
2795 {
2796 if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_WAVE)
2797 {
2798 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2799 x_draw_underwave (s);
2800 else
2801 {
2802 XGCValues xgcv;
2803 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2804 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2805 x_draw_underwave (s);
2806 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2807 }
2808 }
2809 else if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
2810 {
2811 unsigned long thickness, position;
2812 int y;
2813
2814 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2815 {
2816 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2817 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2818 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2819 }
2820 else
2821 {
2822 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2823 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2824 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2825 else
2826 thickness = 1;
2827 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2828 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2829 else
2830 {
2831 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2832 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2833 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2834 specs, and its default is
2835
2836 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2837 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2838
2839 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2840 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2841 position = s->font->underline_position;
2842 else if (s->font)
2843 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2844 else
2845 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2846 }
2847 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2848 }
2849 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2850 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2851 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2852 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2853 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2854 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2855 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2856 s->underline_position = position;
2857 y = s->ybase + position;
2858 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2859 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2860 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2861 else
2862 {
2863 XGCValues xgcv;
2864 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2865 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2866 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2867 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2868 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2869 }
2870 }
2871 }
2872 /* Draw overline. */
2873 if (s->face->overline_p)
2874 {
2875 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2876
2877 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2878 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2879 s->width, h);
2880 else
2881 {
2882 XGCValues xgcv;
2883 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2884 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2885 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2886 s->width, h);
2887 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2888 }
2889 }
2890
2891 /* Draw strike-through. */
2892 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2893 {
2894 unsigned long h = 1;
2895 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2896
2897 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2898 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2899 s->width, h);
2900 else
2901 {
2902 XGCValues xgcv;
2903 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2904 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2905 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2906 s->width, h);
2907 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2908 }
2909 }
2910
2911 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2912 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2913 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2914
2915 if (s->prev)
2916 {
2917 struct glyph_string *prev;
2918
2919 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2920 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2921 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2922 {
2923 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2924 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2925 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2926
2927 prev->hl = s->hl;
2928 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2929 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2930 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2931 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2932 else
2933 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2934 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2935 prev->hl = save;
2936 prev->num_clips = 0;
2937 }
2938 }
2939
2940 if (s->next)
2941 {
2942 struct glyph_string *next;
2943
2944 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2945 if (next->hl != s->hl
2946 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2947 {
2948 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2949 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2950 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2951
2952 next->hl = s->hl;
2953 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2954 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2955 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2956 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2957 else
2958 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2959 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2960 next->hl = save;
2961 next->num_clips = 0;
2962 next->clip_head = s->next;
2963 }
2964 }
2965 }
2966
2967 /* Reset clipping. */
2968 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2969 s->num_clips = 0;
2970 }
2971
2972 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2973
2974 static void
2975 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2976 {
2977 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2978 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2979 x, y, width, height,
2980 x + shift_by, y);
2981 }
2982
2983 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2984 for X frames. */
2985
2986 static void
2987 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
2988 {
2989 emacs_abort ();
2990 }
2991
2992
2993 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2994 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2995
2996 void
2997 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
2998 {
2999 eassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
3000 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
3001 }
3002
3003
3004 /* Clear an entire frame. */
3005
3006 static void
3007 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
3008 {
3009 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
3010 longer visible. */
3011 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
3012 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
3013 output_cursor.x = -1;
3014
3015 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
3016 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
3017 block_input ();
3018
3019 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
3020
3021 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
3022 something like that, then they should be notified. */
3023 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
3024
3025 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3026 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
3027 redisplay, do it here. */
3028 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
3029 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3030 #endif
3031
3032 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3033
3034 unblock_input ();
3035 }
3036
3037
3038 \f
3039 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
3040
3041 static void
3042 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3043 {
3044 block_input ();
3045
3046 {
3047 #ifdef USE_GTK
3048 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3049 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3050 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3051 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3052 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3053 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3054 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3055 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3056 do { \
3057 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3058 cairo_fill (cr); \
3059 } \
3060 while (0)
3061 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3062 GdkGCValues vals;
3063 GdkGC *gc;
3064 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3065 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3066 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3067 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3068 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3069 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3070 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3071 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3072 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3073 GC gc;
3074
3075 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3076 pixels into background pixels. */
3077 {
3078 XGCValues values;
3079
3080 values.function = GXxor;
3081 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3082 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3083
3084 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3085 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3086 }
3087 #endif
3088 {
3089 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3090 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3091 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3092 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3093 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3094 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3095 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3096
3097 int width;
3098
3099 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3100 edge it is next to. */
3101 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3102 {
3103 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3104 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3105 break;
3106
3107 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3108 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3109 break;
3110
3111 default:
3112 break;
3113 }
3114
3115 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3116
3117 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3118 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3119 {
3120 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3121 flash_left,
3122 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3123 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3124 width, flash_height);
3125 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3126 flash_left,
3127 (height - flash_height
3128 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3129 width, flash_height);
3130
3131 }
3132 else
3133 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3134 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3135 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3136 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3137
3138 x_flush (f);
3139
3140 {
3141 EMACS_TIME delay = make_emacs_time (0, 150 * 1000 * 1000);
3142 EMACS_TIME wakeup = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), delay);
3143
3144 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3145 available. */
3146 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3147 {
3148 EMACS_TIME current = current_emacs_time ();
3149 EMACS_TIME timeout;
3150
3151 /* Break if result would not be positive. */
3152 if (EMACS_TIME_LE (wakeup, current))
3153 break;
3154
3155 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3156 timeout = make_emacs_time (0, 10 * 1000 * 1000);
3157
3158 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3159 pselect (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout, NULL);
3160 }
3161 }
3162
3163 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3164 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3165 {
3166 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3167 flash_left,
3168 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3169 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3170 width, flash_height);
3171 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3172 flash_left,
3173 (height - flash_height
3174 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3175 width, flash_height);
3176 }
3177 else
3178 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3179 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3180 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3181 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3182
3183 #ifdef USE_GTK
3184 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3185 cairo_destroy (cr);
3186 #else
3187 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3188 #endif
3189 #undef XFillRectangle
3190 #else
3191 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3192 #endif
3193 x_flush (f);
3194 }
3195 }
3196
3197 unblock_input ();
3198 }
3199
3200
3201 static void
3202 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3203 {
3204 block_input ();
3205 if (invisible)
3206 {
3207 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3208 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3209 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3210 }
3211 else
3212 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3213 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3214 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3215 unblock_input ();
3216 }
3217
3218
3219 /* Make audible bell. */
3220
3221 static void
3222 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3223 {
3224 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3225 {
3226 if (visible_bell)
3227 XTflash (f);
3228 else
3229 {
3230 block_input ();
3231 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3232 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3233 unblock_input ();
3234 }
3235 }
3236 }
3237
3238 \f
3239 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3240 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3241 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3242 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3243
3244 static void
3245 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3246 {
3247 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3248 }
3249
3250
3251 \f
3252 /***********************************************************************
3253 Line Dance
3254 ***********************************************************************/
3255
3256 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3257 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3258
3259 static void
3260 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3261 {
3262 emacs_abort ();
3263 }
3264
3265
3266 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3267
3268 static void
3269 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3270 {
3271 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3272 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3273
3274 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3275 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3276 fringe of W. */
3277 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3278
3279 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3280 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
3281 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
3282 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
3283 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
3284 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
3285 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
3286 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
3287 {
3288 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
3289
3290 if (sb_width > 0)
3291 {
3292 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
3293 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
3294 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
3295
3296 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == x)
3297 {
3298 x = bar_area_x + sb_width;
3299 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3300 }
3301 else if (x + width == bar_area_x)
3302 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3303 }
3304 }
3305 #endif
3306
3307 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3308 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3309 bottom_y = y + height;
3310
3311 if (to_y < from_y)
3312 {
3313 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3314 line at the bottom. */
3315 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3316 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3317 else
3318 height = run->height;
3319 }
3320 else
3321 {
3322 /* Scrolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3323 at the bottom. */
3324 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3325 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3326 else
3327 height = run->height;
3328 }
3329
3330 block_input ();
3331
3332 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3333 updated_window = w;
3334 x_clear_cursor (w);
3335
3336 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3337 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3338 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3339 x, from_y,
3340 width, height,
3341 x, to_y);
3342
3343 unblock_input ();
3344 }
3345
3346
3347 \f
3348 /***********************************************************************
3349 Exposure Events
3350 ***********************************************************************/
3351
3352 \f
3353 static void
3354 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3355 {
3356 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3357 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3358 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3359 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3360 block_input ();
3361 /* I recently started to get errors in this XSetWindowBorder, depending on
3362 the window-manager in use, tho something more is at play since I've been
3363 using that same window-manager binary for ever. Let's not crash just
3364 because of this (bug#9310). */
3365 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3366 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3367 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3368 x_uncatch_errors ();
3369 unblock_input ();
3370 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3371 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3372 }
3373
3374 static void
3375 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3376 {
3377 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3378 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3379 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3380 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3381 block_input ();
3382 /* Same as above for XSetWindowBorder (bug#9310). */
3383 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3384 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3385 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3386 x_uncatch_errors ();
3387 unblock_input ();
3388 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3389 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3390 }
3391
3392 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3393 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3394 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3395 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3396 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3397
3398 static void
3399 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3400 {
3401 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3402
3403 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3404 {
3405 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3406 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3407 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3408
3409 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3410 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3411
3412 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3413 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3414 else
3415 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3416 }
3417
3418 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3419 }
3420
3421 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3422 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3423 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3424
3425 static void
3426 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3427 {
3428 if (type == FocusIn)
3429 {
3430 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3431 {
3432 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3433 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3434
3435 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3436 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3437 /* When run as a daemon, Vterminal_frame is always NIL. */
3438 if ((NILP (Vterminal_frame) || EQ (Fdaemonp(), Qt))
3439 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3440 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3441 {
3442 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3443 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3444 }
3445 }
3446
3447 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3448
3449 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3450 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3451 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3452 #endif
3453 }
3454 else if (type == FocusOut)
3455 {
3456 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3457
3458 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3459 {
3460 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3461 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3462 }
3463
3464 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3465 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3466 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3467 #endif
3468 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3469 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3470 }
3471 }
3472
3473 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3474 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3475
3476 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3477
3478 static void
3479 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3480 {
3481 struct frame *frame;
3482
3483 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3484 if (! frame)
3485 return;
3486
3487 switch (event->type)
3488 {
3489 case EnterNotify:
3490 case LeaveNotify:
3491 {
3492 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3493 int focus_state
3494 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3495
3496 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3497 && event->xcrossing.focus
3498 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3499 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3500 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3501 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3502 }
3503 break;
3504
3505 case FocusIn:
3506 case FocusOut:
3507 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3508 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3509 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3510 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3511 break;
3512
3513 case ClientMessage:
3514 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3515 {
3516 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3517 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3518 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3519 }
3520 break;
3521 }
3522 }
3523
3524
3525 #if defined HAVE_MENUS && !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3526 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3527
3528 void
3529 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3530 {
3531 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3532 }
3533 #endif
3534
3535 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3536 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3537 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3538
3539 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3540 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3541 the appropriate X display info. */
3542
3543 static void
3544 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3545 {
3546 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3547 }
3548
3549 static void
3550 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3551 {
3552 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3553
3554 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3555 {
3556 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3557 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3558 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3559 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3560 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3561 {
3562 fset_focus_frame (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame, Qnil);
3563 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3564 }
3565 }
3566 else
3567 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3568
3569 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3570 {
3571 if (old_highlight)
3572 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3573 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3574 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3575 }
3576 }
3577
3578
3579 \f
3580 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3581
3582 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3583 static void
3584 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3585 {
3586 int min_code, max_code;
3587 KeySym *syms;
3588 int syms_per_code;
3589 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3590
3591 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3592 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3593 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3594 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3595 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3596
3597 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3598
3599 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3600 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3601 &syms_per_code);
3602 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3603
3604 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3605 Alt keysyms are on. */
3606 {
3607 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3608 int found_alt_or_meta;
3609
3610 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3611 {
3612 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3613 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3614 {
3615 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3616
3617 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3618 if (code == 0)
3619 continue;
3620
3621 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3622 {
3623 int code_col;
3624
3625 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3626 {
3627 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3628
3629 switch (sym)
3630 {
3631 case XK_Meta_L:
3632 case XK_Meta_R:
3633 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3634 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3635 break;
3636
3637 case XK_Alt_L:
3638 case XK_Alt_R:
3639 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3640 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3641 break;
3642
3643 case XK_Hyper_L:
3644 case XK_Hyper_R:
3645 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3646 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3647 code_col = syms_per_code;
3648 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3649 break;
3650
3651 case XK_Super_L:
3652 case XK_Super_R:
3653 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3654 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3655 code_col = syms_per_code;
3656 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3657 break;
3658
3659 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3660 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3661 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3662 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3663 code_col = syms_per_code;
3664 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3665 break;
3666 }
3667 }
3668 }
3669 }
3670 }
3671 }
3672
3673 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3674 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3675 {
3676 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3677 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3678 }
3679
3680 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3681 make them just meta, not alt. */
3682 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3683 {
3684 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3685 }
3686
3687 XFree (syms);
3688 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3689 }
3690
3691 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3692 Emacs uses. */
3693
3694 int
3695 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int state)
3696 {
3697 int mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3698 int mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3699 int mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3700 int mod_super = super_modifier;
3701 Lisp_Object tem;
3702
3703 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3704 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3705 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3706 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3707 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3708 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3709 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3710 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3711
3712 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3713 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3714 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3715 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3716 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3717 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3718 }
3719
3720 static int
3721 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, EMACS_INT state)
3722 {
3723 EMACS_INT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3724 EMACS_INT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3725 EMACS_INT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3726 EMACS_INT mod_super = super_modifier;
3727
3728 Lisp_Object tem;
3729
3730 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3731 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem);
3732 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3733 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem);
3734 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3735 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem);
3736 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3737 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem);
3738
3739
3740 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3741 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3742 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3743 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3744 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3745 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3746 }
3747
3748 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3749
3750 char *
3751 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3752 {
3753 char *value;
3754
3755 block_input ();
3756 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3757 unblock_input ();
3758
3759 return value;
3760 }
3761
3762
3763 \f
3764 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3765
3766 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3767
3768 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3769 the mouse. */
3770
3771 static Lisp_Object
3772 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3773 {
3774 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3775 otherwise. */
3776 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3777 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3778 result->timestamp = event->time;
3779 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3780 event->state)
3781 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3782 ? up_modifier
3783 : down_modifier));
3784
3785 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3786 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3787 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3788 result->arg = Qnil;
3789 return Qnil;
3790 }
3791
3792 \f
3793 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3794 The input handler calls this.
3795
3796 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3797 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3798 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3799 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3800
3801 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3802 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3803
3804 static int
3805 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3806 {
3807 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3808 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3809 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3810
3811 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3812 return 0;
3813
3814 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3815 {
3816 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3817 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3818 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3819 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3820 return 1;
3821 }
3822
3823
3824 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3825 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3826 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3827 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3828 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3829 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3830 {
3831 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3832 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3833 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3834 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3835 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3836 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3837 return 1;
3838 }
3839
3840 return 0;
3841 }
3842
3843 \f
3844 /************************************************************************
3845 Mouse Face
3846 ************************************************************************/
3847
3848 static void
3849 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3850 {
3851 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3852 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3853 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3854 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3855 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3856 }
3857
3858
3859
3860 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3861 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3862
3863 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3864 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3865 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3866 position on the scroll bar.
3867
3868 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3869 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3870 the mouse is over.
3871
3872 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3873 was at this position.
3874
3875 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3876
3877 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3878 movement. */
3879
3880 static void
3881 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
3882 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
3883 Time *timestamp)
3884 {
3885 FRAME_PTR f1;
3886
3887 block_input ();
3888
3889 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3890 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3891 else
3892 {
3893 Window root;
3894 int root_x, root_y;
3895
3896 Window dummy_window;
3897 int dummy;
3898
3899 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3900
3901 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3902 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3903 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3904 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3905 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3906
3907 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3908
3909 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3910 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3911 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3912
3913 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3914 &root,
3915
3916 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3917 a different screen. */
3918 &dummy_window,
3919
3920 /* The position on that root window. */
3921 &root_x, &root_y,
3922
3923 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3924 &dummy, &dummy,
3925
3926 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3927 we don't care. */
3928 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3929
3930 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3931 containing the pointer. */
3932 {
3933 Window win, child;
3934 int win_x, win_y;
3935 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3936
3937 win = root;
3938
3939 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3940 structure is changing at the same time this function
3941 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3942
3943 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3944
3945 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3946 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3947 {
3948 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3949 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3950 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3951
3952 /* From-window, to-window. */
3953 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3954
3955 /* From-position, to-position. */
3956 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3957
3958 /* Child of win. */
3959 &child);
3960 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3961 }
3962 else
3963 {
3964 while (1)
3965 {
3966 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3967
3968 /* From-window, to-window. */
3969 root, win,
3970
3971 /* From-position, to-position. */
3972 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3973
3974 /* Child of win. */
3975 &child);
3976
3977 if (child == None || child == win)
3978 break;
3979 #ifdef USE_GTK
3980 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3981 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3982 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3983 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3984 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3985 break;
3986 #endif
3987 win = child;
3988 parent_x = win_x;
3989 parent_y = win_y;
3990 }
3991
3992 /* Now we know that:
3993 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3994 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3995 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3996 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3997 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3998 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3999 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
4000 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
4001 never use them in that case.) */
4002
4003 #ifdef USE_GTK
4004 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4005 want the edit window. */
4006 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4007 #else
4008 /* Is win one of our frames? */
4009 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4010 #endif
4011
4012 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4013 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4014 on the frame. */
4015 if (f1 != NULL
4016 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
4017 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
4018 f1 = NULL;
4019 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4020 }
4021
4022 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
4023 f1 = 0;
4024
4025 x_uncatch_errors ();
4026
4027 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4028 if (! f1)
4029 {
4030 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4031
4032 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
4033
4034 if (bar)
4035 {
4036 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4037 win_x = parent_x;
4038 win_y = parent_y;
4039 }
4040 }
4041
4042 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
4043 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
4044
4045 if (f1)
4046 {
4047 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4048 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4049 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4050 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4051 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4052 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4053 the frame are divided into. */
4054
4055 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
4056 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4057
4058 *bar_window = Qnil;
4059 *part = 0;
4060 *fp = f1;
4061 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4062 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4063 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
4064 }
4065 }
4066 }
4067
4068 unblock_input ();
4069 }
4070
4071
4072 \f
4073 /***********************************************************************
4074 Scroll bars
4075 ***********************************************************************/
4076
4077 /* Scroll bar support. */
4078
4079 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4080 manages it.
4081 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4082 bits. */
4083
4084 static struct scroll_bar *
4085 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4086 {
4087 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
4088
4089 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4090 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4091 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4092
4093 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4094 {
4095 Lisp_Object bar, condemned;
4096
4097 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4098 continue;
4099
4100 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4101 right window ID. */
4102 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4103 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4104 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4105 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4106 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4107 condemned = Qnil,
4108 ! NILP (bar));
4109 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4110 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4111 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4112 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4113 }
4114
4115 return NULL;
4116 }
4117
4118
4119 #if defined USE_LUCID
4120
4121 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4122 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4123
4124 static Widget
4125 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4126 {
4127 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
4128
4129 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4130 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4131 {
4132 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4133
4134 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4135 return menu_bar;
4136 }
4137 return NULL;
4138 }
4139
4140 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4141
4142 \f
4143 /************************************************************************
4144 Toolkit scroll bars
4145 ************************************************************************/
4146
4147 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4148
4149 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4150 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4151 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4152 struct scroll_bar *);
4153 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4154 int, int, int);
4155
4156
4157 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4158 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4159
4160 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4161
4162 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4163
4164 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4165
4166 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4167 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4168
4169 #ifndef USE_GTK
4170 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4171
4172 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4173
4174 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4175
4176 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4177 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4178 to avoid jerkiness. */
4179
4180 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4181
4182 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4183 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4184 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4185 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4186
4187 static void
4188 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4189 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4190 {
4191 int scroll_bar_p;
4192 const char *end_action;
4193
4194 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4195 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4196 end_action = "Release";
4197 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4198 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4199 end_action = "EndScroll";
4200 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4201
4202 if (scroll_bar_p
4203 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4204 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4205 {
4206 struct window *w;
4207
4208 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4209 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4210 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4211
4212 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4213 {
4214 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4215 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4216 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4217 }
4218 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4219 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4220
4221 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4222 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4223 }
4224 }
4225 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4226
4227 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4228 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4229
4230 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4231 static ptrdiff_t scroll_bar_windows_size;
4232
4233
4234 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4235 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4236 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4237 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4238
4239 static void
4240 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4241 {
4242 XEvent event;
4243 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4244 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4245 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4246 ptrdiff_t i;
4247
4248 block_input ();
4249
4250 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4251 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4252 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4253 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4254 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4255 ev->format = 32;
4256
4257 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4258 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4259 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4260 into that array in the event. */
4261 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4262 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4263 break;
4264
4265 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4266 {
4267 ptrdiff_t old_nbytes =
4268 scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4269 ptrdiff_t nbytes;
4270 enum { XClientMessageEvent_MAX = 0x7fffffff };
4271 scroll_bar_windows =
4272 xpalloc (scroll_bar_windows, &scroll_bar_windows_size, 1,
4273 XClientMessageEvent_MAX, sizeof *scroll_bar_windows);
4274 nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4275 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4276 }
4277
4278 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4279 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4280 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4281 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4282 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4283 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4284
4285 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4286 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4287 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4288 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4289 #endif
4290
4291 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4292 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4293 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4294 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4295 unblock_input ();
4296 }
4297
4298
4299 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4300 in *IEVENT. */
4301
4302 static void
4303 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4304 {
4305 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4306 Lisp_Object window;
4307 struct window *w;
4308
4309 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4310 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4311
4312 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4313
4314 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4315 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4316 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4317 #ifdef USE_GTK
4318 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4319 #else
4320 ievent->timestamp =
4321 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
4322 #endif
4323 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4324 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4325 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4326 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4327 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4328 }
4329
4330
4331 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4332
4333 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4334
4335 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4336
4337
4338 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4339 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4340 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4341
4342 static void
4343 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4344 {
4345 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4346 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4347 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4348
4349 switch (cs->reason)
4350 {
4351 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4352 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4353 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4354 break;
4355
4356 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4357 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4358 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4359 break;
4360
4361 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4362 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4363 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4364 break;
4365
4366 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4367 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4368 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4369 break;
4370
4371 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4372 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4373 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4374 break;
4375
4376 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4377 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4378 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4379 break;
4380
4381 case XmCR_DRAG:
4382 {
4383 int slider_size;
4384
4385 /* Get the slider size. */
4386 block_input ();
4387 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4388 unblock_input ();
4389
4390 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4391 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4392 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4393 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4394 }
4395 break;
4396
4397 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4398 break;
4399 };
4400
4401 if (part >= 0)
4402 {
4403 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4404 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4405 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4406 }
4407 }
4408
4409 #elif defined USE_GTK
4410
4411 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4412 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4413
4414 static gboolean
4415 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4416 GtkScrollType scroll,
4417 gdouble value,
4418 gpointer user_data)
4419 {
4420 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4421 gdouble position;
4422 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4423 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4424 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4425
4426 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4427 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4428
4429
4430 switch (scroll)
4431 {
4432 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4433 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4434 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4435 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4436 {
4437 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4438 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4439 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4440 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4441 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4442 }
4443 break;
4444 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4445 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4446 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4447 break;
4448 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4449 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4450 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4451 break;
4452 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4453 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4454 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4455 break;
4456 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4457 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4458 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4459 break;
4460 }
4461
4462 if (part >= 0)
4463 {
4464 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4465 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4466 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4467 }
4468
4469 return FALSE;
4470 }
4471
4472 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4473
4474 static gboolean
4475 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4476 GdkEventButton *event,
4477 gpointer user_data)
4478 {
4479 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4480 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4481 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4482 {
4483 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4484 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4485 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4486 }
4487
4488 return FALSE;
4489 }
4490
4491
4492 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4493
4494 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4495 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4496 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4497 the thumb is. */
4498
4499 static void
4500 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4501 {
4502 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4503 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4504 float shown;
4505 int whole, portion, height;
4506 int part;
4507
4508 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4509 block_input ();
4510 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4511 unblock_input ();
4512
4513 whole = 10000000;
4514 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4515
4516 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0f / height))
4517 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4518 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4519 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4520 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4521 bottom). */
4522 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4523 else
4524 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4525
4526 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4527 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4528 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4529 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4530 }
4531
4532
4533 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4534 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4535 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4536 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4537 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4538 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4539 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4540
4541 static void
4542 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4543 {
4544 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4545 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4546 int position = (long) call_data;
4547 Dimension height;
4548 int part;
4549
4550 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4551 block_input ();
4552 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4553 unblock_input ();
4554
4555 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4556 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4557
4558 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4559 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4560 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4561 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4562 else
4563 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4564
4565 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4566 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4567 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4568 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4569 }
4570
4571 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4572
4573 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4574
4575 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4576 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4577
4578 #ifdef USE_GTK
4579 static void
4580 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4581 {
4582 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4583
4584 block_input ();
4585 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4586 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4587 scroll_bar_name);
4588 unblock_input ();
4589 }
4590
4591 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4592
4593 static void
4594 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4595 {
4596 Window xwindow;
4597 Widget widget;
4598 Arg av[20];
4599 int ac = 0;
4600 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4601 unsigned long pixel;
4602
4603 block_input ();
4604
4605 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4606 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4607 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4608 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4609 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4610 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4611 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4612 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4613 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4614
4615 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4616 if (pixel != -1)
4617 {
4618 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4619 ++ac;
4620 }
4621
4622 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4623 if (pixel != -1)
4624 {
4625 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4626 ++ac;
4627 }
4628
4629 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4630 (char *) scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4631
4632 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4633 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4634 (XtPointer) bar);
4635 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4636 (XtPointer) bar);
4637 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4638 (XtPointer) bar);
4639 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4640 (XtPointer) bar);
4641 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4642 (XtPointer) bar);
4643 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4644 (XtPointer) bar);
4645 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4646 (XtPointer) bar);
4647
4648 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4649 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4650
4651 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4652 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4653 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4654 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4655
4656 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4657
4658 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4659 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4660 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4661 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4662 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4663 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4664 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4665 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4666
4667 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4668 if (pixel != -1)
4669 {
4670 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4671 ++ac;
4672 }
4673
4674 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4675 if (pixel != -1)
4676 {
4677 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4678 ++ac;
4679 }
4680
4681 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4682
4683 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4684 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4685 {
4686 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4687 if (pixel != -1)
4688 {
4689 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4690 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4691 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4692 pixel = -1;
4693 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4694 }
4695 }
4696 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4697 {
4698 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4699 if (pixel != -1)
4700 {
4701 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4702 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4703 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4704 pixel = -1;
4705 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4706 }
4707 }
4708
4709 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4710 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4711 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4712 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4713 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4714 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4715 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4716 colors itself. */
4717 {
4718 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4719 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4720 ++ac;
4721 }
4722 else
4723 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4724 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4725 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4726 {
4727 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4728 the shadows. */
4729 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4730 ++ac;
4731
4732 /* Specify the colors. */
4733 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4734 if (pixel != -1)
4735 {
4736 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4737 ++ac;
4738 }
4739 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4740 if (pixel != -1)
4741 {
4742 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4743 ++ac;
4744 }
4745 }
4746 #endif
4747
4748 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4749 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4750
4751 {
4752 char const *initial = "";
4753 char const *val = initial;
4754 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4755 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4756 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4757 #endif
4758 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4759 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4760 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4761 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4762 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4763 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4764 }
4765 }
4766
4767 /* Define callbacks. */
4768 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4769 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4770 (XtPointer) bar);
4771
4772 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4773 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4774
4775 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4776
4777 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4778 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4779 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4780 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4781
4782 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4783 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4784 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4785 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4786
4787 unblock_input ();
4788 }
4789 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4790
4791
4792 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4793 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4794
4795 #ifdef USE_GTK
4796 static void
4797 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4798 {
4799 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4800 }
4801
4802 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4803 static void
4804 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4805 int whole)
4806 {
4807 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4808 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4809 float top, shown;
4810
4811 block_input ();
4812
4813 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4814
4815 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4816 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4817 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4818 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4819 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4820 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4821 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4822 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4823 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4824 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4825 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4826 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4827 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4828 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4829 whole += portion;
4830
4831 if (whole <= 0)
4832 top = 0, shown = 1;
4833 else
4834 {
4835 top = (float) position / whole;
4836 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4837 }
4838
4839 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4840 {
4841 int size, value;
4842
4843 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4844 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4845 value. */
4846 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4847 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4848 size = max (size, 1);
4849
4850 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4851 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4852 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4853
4854 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4855 }
4856 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4857
4858 if (whole == 0)
4859 top = 0, shown = 1;
4860 else
4861 {
4862 top = (float) position / whole;
4863 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4864 }
4865
4866 {
4867 float old_top, old_shown;
4868 Dimension height;
4869 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4870 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4871 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4872 XtNheight, &height,
4873 NULL);
4874
4875 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4876 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4877 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4878 else
4879 top = old_top;
4880 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4881 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0f / height), shown));
4882
4883 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4884 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4885 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4886 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4887 {
4888 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4889 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4890 else
4891 {
4892 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4893 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4894 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4895
4896 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4897 }
4898 }
4899 }
4900 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4901
4902 unblock_input ();
4903 }
4904 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4905
4906 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4907
4908
4909 \f
4910 /************************************************************************
4911 Scroll bars, general
4912 ************************************************************************/
4913
4914 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4915 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4916 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4917 scroll bar. */
4918
4919 static struct scroll_bar *
4920 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4921 {
4922 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4923 struct scroll_bar *bar
4924 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4925 Lisp_Object barobj;
4926
4927 block_input ();
4928
4929 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4930 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4931 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4932 {
4933 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4934 unsigned long mask;
4935 Window window;
4936
4937 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4938 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4939 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4940
4941 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4942 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4943 | ExposureMask);
4944 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4945
4946 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4947
4948 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4949 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4950 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4951 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4952 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4953 left, top, width,
4954 window_box_height (w), False);
4955
4956 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4957 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4958 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4959 top,
4960 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4961 height,
4962 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4963 0,
4964 CopyFromParent,
4965 CopyFromParent,
4966 CopyFromParent,
4967 /* Attributes. */
4968 mask, &a);
4969 bar->x_window = window;
4970 }
4971 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4972
4973 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4974 bar->top = top;
4975 bar->left = left;
4976 bar->width = width;
4977 bar->height = height;
4978 bar->start = 0;
4979 bar->end = 0;
4980 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4981 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
4982
4983 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4984 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4985 bar->prev = Qnil;
4986 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
4987 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
4988 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4989 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4990
4991 /* Map the window/widget. */
4992 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4993 {
4994 #ifdef USE_GTK
4995 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4996 bar->x_window,
4997 top,
4998 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4999 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5000 max (height, 1));
5001 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5002 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
5003 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
5004 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5005 top,
5006 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5007 max (height, 1), 0);
5008 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
5009 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5010 }
5011 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5012 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5013 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5014
5015 unblock_input ();
5016 return bar;
5017 }
5018
5019
5020 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5021
5022 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5023
5024 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5025 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
5026 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5027 events.)
5028
5029 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5030 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5031 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5032 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5033 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5034
5035 static void
5036 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
5037 {
5038 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
5039 Window w = bar->x_window;
5040 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5041 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5042
5043 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5044 if (! rebuild
5045 && start == bar->start
5046 && end == bar->end)
5047 return;
5048
5049 block_input ();
5050
5051 {
5052 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5053 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5054 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5055
5056 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5057 the distance between start and end. */
5058 {
5059 int length = end - start;
5060
5061 if (start < 0)
5062 start = 0;
5063 else if (start > top_range)
5064 start = top_range;
5065 end = start + length;
5066
5067 if (end < start)
5068 end = start;
5069 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5070 end = top_range;
5071 }
5072
5073 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5074 bar->start = start;
5075 bar->end = end;
5076
5077 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5078 if (end > top_range)
5079 end = top_range;
5080
5081 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5082 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5083 that many pixels tall. */
5084 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5085
5086 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5087 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5088 if (0 < start)
5089 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5090 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5091 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5092 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5093 inside_width, start,
5094 False);
5095
5096 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5097 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5098 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5099 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5100
5101 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5102 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5103 /* x, y, width, height */
5104 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5105 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5106 inside_width, end - start);
5107
5108 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5109 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5110 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5111 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5112
5113 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5114 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5115 if (end < inside_height)
5116 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5117 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5118 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5119 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5120 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5121 False);
5122
5123 }
5124
5125 unblock_input ();
5126 }
5127
5128 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5129
5130 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5131 nil. */
5132
5133 static void
5134 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5135 {
5136 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5137 block_input ();
5138
5139 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5140 #ifdef USE_GTK
5141 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5142 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5143 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5144 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5145 #else
5146 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5147 #endif
5148
5149 /* Dissociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5150 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (XWINDOW (bar->window), Qnil);
5151
5152 unblock_input ();
5153 }
5154
5155
5156 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5157 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5158 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5159 create one. */
5160
5161 static void
5162 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5163 {
5164 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5165 Lisp_Object barobj;
5166 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5167 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5168 int window_y, window_height;
5169 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5170 int fringe_extended_p;
5171 #endif
5172
5173 /* Get window dimensions. */
5174 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5175 top = window_y;
5176 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5177 height = window_height;
5178
5179 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5180 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5181
5182 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5183 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5184 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5185 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5186 else
5187 sb_width = width;
5188
5189 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5190 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5191 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5192 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5193 else
5194 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5195 #else
5196 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5197 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5198 else
5199 sb_left = left;
5200 #endif
5201
5202 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5203 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5204 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5205 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5206 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5207 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5208 else
5209 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5210 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5211 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5212 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5213 #endif
5214
5215 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5216 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5217 {
5218 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5219 {
5220 block_input ();
5221 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5222 if (fringe_extended_p)
5223 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5224 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5225 else
5226 #endif
5227 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5228 left, top, width, height, False);
5229 unblock_input ();
5230 }
5231
5232 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5233 }
5234 else
5235 {
5236 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5237 unsigned int mask = 0;
5238
5239 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5240
5241 block_input ();
5242
5243 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5244 mask |= CWX;
5245 if (top != bar->top)
5246 mask |= CWY;
5247 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5248 mask |= CWWidth;
5249 if (height != bar->height)
5250 mask |= CWHeight;
5251
5252 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5253
5254 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5255 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5256 {
5257 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5258 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5259 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5260 {
5261 if (fringe_extended_p)
5262 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5263 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5264 else
5265 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5266 left, top, width, height, False);
5267 }
5268 #ifdef USE_GTK
5269 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5270 bar->x_window,
5271 top,
5272 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5273 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5274 max (height, 1));
5275 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5276 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5277 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5278 top,
5279 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5280 max (height, 1), 0);
5281 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5282 }
5283 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5284
5285 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5286 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5287 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5288 {
5289 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5290 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5291 height, False);
5292 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5293 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5294 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5295 height, False);
5296 }
5297
5298 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5299 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5300 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5301 example. */
5302 {
5303 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5304 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5305 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5306 {
5307 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5308 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5309 left + area_width - rest, top,
5310 rest, height, False);
5311 else
5312 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5313 left, top, rest, height, False);
5314 }
5315 }
5316
5317 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5318 if (mask)
5319 {
5320 XWindowChanges wc;
5321
5322 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5323 wc.y = top;
5324 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5325 wc.height = height;
5326 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5327 mask, &wc);
5328 }
5329
5330 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5331
5332 /* Remember new settings. */
5333 bar->left = sb_left;
5334 bar->top = top;
5335 bar->width = sb_width;
5336 bar->height = height;
5337
5338 unblock_input ();
5339 }
5340
5341 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5342 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5343
5344 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5345 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5346 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5347 dragged. */
5348 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5349 {
5350 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5351
5352 if (whole == 0)
5353 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5354 else
5355 {
5356 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5357 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5358 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5359 }
5360 }
5361 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5362
5363 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5364 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, barobj);
5365 }
5366
5367
5368 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5369 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5370 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5371 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5372 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5373 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5374 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5375
5376 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5377 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5378 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5379
5380 static void
5381 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5382 {
5383 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5384 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5385 {
5386 Lisp_Object bar;
5387 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5388 fset_scroll_bars (frame, XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next);
5389 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5390 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5391 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5392 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5393 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (frame, bar);
5394 }
5395 }
5396
5397
5398 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5399 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5400
5401 static void
5402 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5403 {
5404 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5405 struct frame *f;
5406 Lisp_Object barobj;
5407
5408 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5409 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5410 emacs_abort ();
5411
5412 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5413
5414 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5415 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5416 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5417 {
5418 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5419 the lists. */
5420 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5421 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5422 return;
5423 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5424 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5425 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, bar->next);
5426 else
5427 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5428 one or the other! */
5429 emacs_abort ();
5430 }
5431 else
5432 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5433
5434 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5435 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5436
5437 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5438 bar->prev = Qnil;
5439 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5440 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
5441 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5442 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5443 }
5444
5445 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5446 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5447
5448 static void
5449 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5450 {
5451 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5452
5453 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5454
5455 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5456 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5457 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, Qnil);
5458
5459 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5460 {
5461 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5462
5463 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5464
5465 next = b->next;
5466 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5467 }
5468
5469 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5470 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5471 }
5472
5473
5474 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5475 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5476 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5477
5478 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5479 mark bits. */
5480
5481 static void
5482 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5483 {
5484 Window w = bar->x_window;
5485 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5486 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5487 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5488
5489 block_input ();
5490
5491 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5492
5493 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5494 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5495 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5496 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5497
5498 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5499 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5500
5501 /* x, y, width, height */
5502 0, 0,
5503 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5504 bar->height - 1);
5505
5506 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5507 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5508 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5509 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5510
5511 unblock_input ();
5512
5513 }
5514 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5515
5516 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5517 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5518
5519 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5520 mark bits. */
5521
5522
5523 static void
5524 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5525 {
5526 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5527 emacs_abort ();
5528
5529 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5530 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5531 emacs_event->modifiers
5532 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5533 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5534 event->xbutton.state)
5535 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5536 ? up_modifier
5537 : down_modifier));
5538 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5539 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5540 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5541 {
5542 int top_range
5543 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5544 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5545
5546 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5547 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5548
5549 if (y < bar->start)
5550 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5551 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5552 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5553 else
5554 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5555
5556 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5557 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5558 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5559 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5560 {
5561 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5562 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5563
5564 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5565 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5566 }
5567 #endif
5568
5569 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5570 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5571 }
5572 }
5573
5574 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5575
5576 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5577
5578 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5579 mark bits. */
5580
5581 static void
5582 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5583 {
5584 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5585
5586 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5587
5588 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5589 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5590
5591 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5592 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5593 {
5594 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5595 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5596
5597 if (new_start != bar->start)
5598 {
5599 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5600
5601 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5602 }
5603 }
5604 }
5605
5606 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5607
5608 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5609 on the scroll bar. */
5610
5611 static void
5612 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
5613 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
5614 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
5615 {
5616 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5617 Window w = bar->x_window;
5618 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5619 int win_x, win_y;
5620 Window dummy_window;
5621 int dummy_coord;
5622 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5623
5624 block_input ();
5625
5626 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5627 report that. */
5628 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5629
5630 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5631 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5632 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5633
5634 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5635 &win_x, &win_y,
5636
5637 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5638 &dummy_mask))
5639 ;
5640 else
5641 {
5642 int top_range
5643 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5644
5645 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5646
5647 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5648 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5649
5650 if (win_y < 0)
5651 win_y = 0;
5652 if (win_y > top_range)
5653 win_y = top_range;
5654
5655 *fp = f;
5656 *bar_window = bar->window;
5657
5658 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5659 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5660 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5661 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5662 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5663 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5664 else
5665 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5666
5667 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5668 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5669
5670 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5671 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5672 }
5673
5674 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
5675
5676 unblock_input ();
5677 }
5678
5679
5680 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5681 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5682 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5683 redraw them. */
5684
5685 static void
5686 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5687 {
5688 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5689 Lisp_Object bar;
5690
5691 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5692 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5693 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5694 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5695 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5696 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5697 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5698 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5699 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5700 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5701 }
5702
5703 \f
5704 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5705
5706 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5707 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5708 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5709 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5710
5711 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5712 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5713
5714 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5715
5716 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5717 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5718
5719 static int temp_index;
5720 static short temp_buffer[100];
5721
5722 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5723 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5724 temp_index = 0; \
5725 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5726
5727 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5728 on a particular display. */
5729
5730 static struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5731
5732 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5733 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5734 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5735 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5736
5737 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5738
5739 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_GTK
5740 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5741 do \
5742 { \
5743 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5744 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = \
5745 xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5746 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5747 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5748 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5749 } \
5750 while (0)
5751 #endif
5752
5753 enum
5754 {
5755 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5756 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5757 X_EVENT_DROP
5758 };
5759
5760 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5761 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5762 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5763
5764 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5765 this event further.
5766 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5767
5768 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5769 static int
5770 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5771 {
5772 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5773 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5774 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5775 was created. */
5776
5777 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5778 event->xclient.window);
5779
5780 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5781 }
5782 #endif
5783
5784 #ifdef USE_GTK
5785 static int current_count;
5786 static int current_finish;
5787 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5788
5789 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5790 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5791 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5792 static GdkFilterReturn
5793 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5794 {
5795 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5796
5797 block_input ();
5798 if (current_count >= 0)
5799 {
5800 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5801
5802 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5803
5804 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5805 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5806 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5807 so we do it here. */
5808 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5809 && dpyinfo
5810 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5811 {
5812 unblock_input ();
5813 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5814 }
5815 #endif
5816
5817 if (! dpyinfo)
5818 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5819 else
5820 current_count +=
5821 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5822 current_hold_quit);
5823 }
5824 else
5825 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5826
5827 unblock_input ();
5828
5829 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5830 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5831
5832 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5833 }
5834 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5835
5836
5837 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time,
5838 enum xembed_message,
5839 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5840
5841 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5842
5843 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5844 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5845 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5846
5847 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5848
5849 static int
5850 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventptr,
5851 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5852 {
5853 union {
5854 struct input_event ie;
5855 struct selection_input_event sie;
5856 } inev;
5857 int count = 0;
5858 int do_help = 0;
5859 ptrdiff_t nbytes = 0;
5860 struct frame *f = NULL;
5861 struct coding_system coding;
5862 XEvent event = *eventptr;
5863 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5864 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5865
5866 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5867
5868 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5869 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5870 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5871
5872 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5873 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5874
5875 switch (event.type)
5876 {
5877 case ClientMessage:
5878 {
5879 if (event.xclient.message_type
5880 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5881 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5882 {
5883 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5884 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5885 {
5886 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5887 could be the shell widget window
5888 if the frame has no title bar. */
5889 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5890 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5891 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5892 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5893 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5894 #endif
5895 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5896 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5897 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5898 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5899 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5900 needed.
5901
5902 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5903 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5904 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5905 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5906 Emacs. */
5907
5908 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5909 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5910 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5911 if (f)
5912 {
5913 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5914 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5915 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5916 x_catch_errors (d);
5917 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5918 /* The ICCCM says this is
5919 the only valid choice. */
5920 RevertToParent,
5921 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5922 /* This is needed to detect the error
5923 if there is an error. */
5924 XSync (d, False);
5925 x_uncatch_errors ();
5926 }
5927 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5928 #endif /* 0 */
5929 goto done;
5930 }
5931
5932 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5933 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5934 {
5935 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5936 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5937 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5938 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5939 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5940 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5941 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5942 session manager and one for this. */
5943 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5944 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5945 #endif
5946 {
5947 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5948 event.xclient.window);
5949 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5950 for a single Emacs process. */
5951 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5952 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5953 event.xclient.window,
5954 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5955 else if (f)
5956 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5957 event.xclient.window,
5958 0, 0);
5959 }
5960 goto done;
5961 }
5962
5963 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5964 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5965 {
5966 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5967 event.xclient.window);
5968 if (!f)
5969 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5970
5971 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5972 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5973 goto done;
5974 }
5975
5976 goto done;
5977 }
5978
5979 if (event.xclient.message_type
5980 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5981 {
5982 goto done;
5983 }
5984
5985 if (event.xclient.message_type
5986 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5987 {
5988 int new_x, new_y;
5989 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5990
5991 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5992 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5993
5994 if (f)
5995 {
5996 f->left_pos = new_x;
5997 f->top_pos = new_y;
5998 }
5999 goto done;
6000 }
6001
6002 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
6003 if (event.xclient.message_type
6004 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
6005 {
6006 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6007 if (f)
6008 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
6009 &event, NULL);
6010 goto done;
6011 }
6012 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6013
6014 if ((event.xclient.message_type
6015 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
6016 || (event.xclient.message_type
6017 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
6018 {
6019 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6020 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6021 currently never do because we are interested in
6022 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6023 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
6024 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6025 if (!f)
6026 goto OTHER;
6027 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
6028 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6029 goto done;
6030 }
6031
6032 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6033 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6034 we construct an input_event. */
6035 if (event.xclient.message_type
6036 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
6037 {
6038 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
6039 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6040 goto done;
6041 }
6042 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6043
6044 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6045 if (event.xclient.message_type
6046 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
6047 {
6048 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
6049 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6050 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6051
6052 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6053 goto done;
6054 }
6055
6056 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6057
6058 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6059 if (!f)
6060 goto OTHER;
6061 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6062 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6063 }
6064 break;
6065
6066 case SelectionNotify:
6067 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6068 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6069 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6070 goto OTHER;
6071 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6072 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6073 break;
6074
6075 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6076 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6077 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6078 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6079 goto OTHER;
6080 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6081 {
6082 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionclear);
6083
6084 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6085 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6086 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6087 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6088 }
6089 break;
6090
6091 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6092 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6093 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6094 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6095 goto OTHER;
6096 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6097 {
6098 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionrequest);
6099
6100 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6101 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6102 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6103 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6104 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6105 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6106 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6107 }
6108 break;
6109
6110 case PropertyNotify:
6111 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6112 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6113 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6114 if (x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty) && f->iconified
6115 && f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen)
6116 {
6117 /* Gnome shell does not iconify us when C-z is pressed. It hides
6118 the frame. So if our state says we aren't hidden anymore,
6119 treat it as deiconified. */
6120 if (! f->async_iconified)
6121 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6122 f->async_visible = 1;
6123 f->async_iconified = 0;
6124 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6125 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 0;
6126 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6127 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6128 }
6129
6130 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6131 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6132 goto OTHER;
6133
6134 case ReparentNotify:
6135 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6136 if (f)
6137 {
6138 int x, y;
6139 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6140 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6141 f->left_pos = x;
6142 f->top_pos = y;
6143
6144 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6145 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6146 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6147
6148 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
6149 }
6150 goto OTHER;
6151
6152 case Expose:
6153 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6154 if (f)
6155 {
6156 #ifdef USE_GTK
6157 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6158 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6159 event.xexpose.window,
6160 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6161 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6162 FALSE);
6163 #endif
6164 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6165 {
6166 f->async_visible = 1;
6167 f->async_iconified = 0;
6168 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6169 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6170 }
6171 else
6172 expose_frame (f,
6173 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6174 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6175 }
6176 else
6177 {
6178 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6179 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6180 #endif
6181 #if defined USE_LUCID
6182 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6183 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6184 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6185 {
6186 Widget widget
6187 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6188 if (widget)
6189 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6190 }
6191 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6192
6193 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6194 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6195 goto OTHER;
6196 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6197 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6198 event.xexpose.window);
6199
6200 if (bar)
6201 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6202 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6203 else
6204 goto OTHER;
6205 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6206 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6207 }
6208 break;
6209
6210 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6211 source area was obscured or not
6212 available. */
6213 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6214 if (f)
6215 {
6216 expose_frame (f,
6217 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6218 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6219 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6220 }
6221 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6222 else
6223 goto OTHER;
6224 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6225 break;
6226
6227 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6228 source area was completely
6229 available. */
6230 break;
6231
6232 case UnmapNotify:
6233 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6234 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6235 {
6236 tip_window = 0;
6237 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6238 }
6239
6240 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6241 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6242 the frame was deleted. */
6243 {
6244 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6245 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6246 display that won't ever be seen. */
6247 f->async_visible = 0;
6248 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6249 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6250 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6251 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6252 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6253 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6254 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6255 {
6256 f->async_iconified = 1;
6257
6258 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6259 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6260 }
6261 }
6262 goto OTHER;
6263
6264 case MapNotify:
6265 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6266 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6267 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6268 goto OTHER;
6269
6270 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6271 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6272 frame is visible. */
6273 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6274 if (f)
6275 {
6276 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6277 the frame's display structures.
6278 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6279 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6280 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6281 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6282 if (! f->async_iconified)
6283 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6284
6285 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6286 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6287 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6288 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6289
6290 f->async_visible = 1;
6291 f->async_iconified = 0;
6292 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6293
6294 if (f->iconified)
6295 {
6296 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6297 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6298 }
6299 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6300 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6301 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6302 to update the frame titles
6303 in case this is the second frame. */
6304 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6305
6306 #ifdef USE_GTK
6307 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6308 #endif
6309 }
6310 goto OTHER;
6311
6312 case KeyPress:
6313
6314 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6315 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6316
6317 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6318 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6319 if (popup_activated ())
6320 goto OTHER;
6321 #endif
6322
6323 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6324
6325 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6326 mouse highlighting. */
6327 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6328 && (f == 0
6329 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6330 {
6331 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6332 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6333 }
6334
6335 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6336 if (f == 0)
6337 {
6338 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6339 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6340 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6341 event.xkey.window);
6342 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6343 {
6344 widget = XtParent (widget);
6345 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6346 }
6347 }
6348 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6349
6350 if (f != 0)
6351 {
6352 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6353 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6354 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6355 his Emacs hang.
6356
6357 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6358 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6359 status_return even if the input is too long to
6360 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6361 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6362 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6363 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6364 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6365 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6366 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6367 int modifiers;
6368 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6369 Lisp_Object c;
6370
6371 #ifdef USE_GTK
6372 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6373 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6374 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6375 (see above). */
6376 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6377 #endif
6378
6379 event.xkey.state
6380 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6381 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6382 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6383
6384 /* This will have to go some day... */
6385
6386 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6387 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6388 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6389 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6390 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6391 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6392 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6393
6394 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6395 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6396 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6397 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6398 not it is combined with Meta. */
6399 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6400 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6401
6402 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6403 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6404 {
6405 Status status_return;
6406
6407 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6408 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6409 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6410 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6411 &status_return);
6412 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6413 {
6414 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6415 copy_bufptr = alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6416 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6417 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6418 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6419 &status_return);
6420 }
6421 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6422 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6423 break;
6424 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6425 {
6426 keysym = NoSymbol;
6427 modifiers = 0;
6428 }
6429 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6430 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6431 emacs_abort ();
6432 }
6433 else
6434 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6435 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6436 &compose_status);
6437 #else
6438 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6439 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6440 &compose_status);
6441 #endif
6442
6443 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6444 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6445 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6446 break;
6447
6448 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6449 orig_keysym = keysym;
6450
6451 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6452 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6453 inev.ie.modifiers
6454 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6455 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6456
6457 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6458 translations to characters. */
6459 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6460 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6461 {
6462 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6463 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6464 goto done_keysym;
6465 }
6466
6467 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6468 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6469 {
6470 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6471 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6472 else
6473 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6474 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6475 goto done_keysym;
6476 }
6477
6478 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6479 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6480 && (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6481 Vx_keysym_table,
6482 Qnil),
6483 NATNUMP (c)))
6484 {
6485 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6486 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6487 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6488 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6489 goto done_keysym;
6490 }
6491
6492 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6493 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6494 || keysym == XK_Delete
6495 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6496 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6497 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6498 #endif
6499 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6500 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6501 #ifdef HPUX
6502 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6503 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6504 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6505 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6506 || (XK_Select <= keysym && keysym < XK_KP_Space)
6507 #endif
6508 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6509 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6510 #endif
6511 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6512 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6513 #endif
6514 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6515 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6516 #endif
6517 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6518 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6519 #endif
6520 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6521 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6522 #endif
6523 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6524 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6525 #endif
6526 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6527 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6528 #endif
6529 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6530 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6531 #endif
6532 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6533 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6534 #endif
6535 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6536 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6537 #endif
6538 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6539 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6540 #endif
6541 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6542 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6543 #endif
6544 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6545 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6546 #endif
6547 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6548 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6549 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6550 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6551 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6552 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6553 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6554 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6555 don't have real modifiers but
6556 should be treated similarly to
6557 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6558 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6559 || (XK_ISO_Lock <= orig_keysym
6560 && orig_keysym <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6561 #endif
6562 ))
6563 {
6564 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6565 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6566 key. */
6567 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6568 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6569 goto done_keysym;
6570 }
6571
6572 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6573 ptrdiff_t i;
6574 int nchars, len;
6575
6576 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6577 {
6578 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6579 nchars++;
6580 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6581 }
6582
6583 if (nchars < nbytes)
6584 {
6585 /* Decode the input data. */
6586
6587 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6588 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6589 we used just above and the locale. */
6590 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6591 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6592 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6593 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6594 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6595 gives us composition information. */
6596 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6597
6598 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding.destination, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH,
6599 nbytes);
6600 coding.dst_bytes = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6601 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6602 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6603 nbytes = coding.produced;
6604 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6605 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6606 }
6607
6608 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6609 character events. */
6610 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6611 {
6612 int ch;
6613 if (nchars == nbytes)
6614 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6615 else
6616 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6617 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
6618 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6619 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6620 inev.ie.code = ch;
6621 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6622 }
6623
6624 count += nchars;
6625
6626 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6627
6628 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6629 break;
6630 }
6631 }
6632 done_keysym:
6633 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6634 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6635 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6636 client. */
6637 break;
6638 #else
6639 goto OTHER;
6640 #endif
6641
6642 case KeyRelease:
6643 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6644 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6645 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6646 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6647 client. */
6648 break;
6649 #else
6650 goto OTHER;
6651 #endif
6652
6653 case EnterNotify:
6654 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6655 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6656
6657 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6658
6659 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6660 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6661
6662 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6663 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6664 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6665 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6666 #ifdef USE_GTK
6667 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6668 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6669 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6670 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6671 #endif
6672 goto OTHER;
6673
6674 case FocusIn:
6675 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6676 goto OTHER;
6677
6678 case LeaveNotify:
6679 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6680 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6681
6682 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6683 if (f)
6684 {
6685 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6686 {
6687 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6688 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6689 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6690 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6691 }
6692
6693 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6694 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6695 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6696 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6697 if (any_help_event_p)
6698 do_help = -1;
6699 }
6700 #ifdef USE_GTK
6701 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6702 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6703 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6704 #endif
6705 goto OTHER;
6706
6707 case FocusOut:
6708 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6709 goto OTHER;
6710
6711 case MotionNotify:
6712 {
6713 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6714 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6715 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6716
6717 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6718 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6719 f = last_mouse_frame;
6720 else
6721 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6722
6723 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6724 {
6725 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6726 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6727 }
6728
6729 #ifdef USE_GTK
6730 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6731 f = 0;
6732 #endif
6733 if (f)
6734 {
6735
6736 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6737 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6738 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6739 {
6740 Lisp_Object window;
6741
6742 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6743 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6744 0, 0);
6745
6746 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6747 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6748 will be selected only when it is active. */
6749 if (WINDOWP (window)
6750 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6751 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6752 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6753 create event iff we don't leave the
6754 selected frame. */
6755 && (focus_follows_mouse
6756 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6757 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6758 {
6759 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6760 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6761 }
6762
6763 last_window=window;
6764 }
6765 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6766 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6767 }
6768 else
6769 {
6770 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6771 struct scroll_bar *bar
6772 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6773 event.xmotion.window);
6774
6775 if (bar)
6776 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6777 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6778
6779 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6780 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6781 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6782 }
6783
6784 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6785 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6786 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6787 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6788 do_help = 1;
6789 goto OTHER;
6790 }
6791
6792 case ConfigureNotify:
6793 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6794 #ifdef USE_GTK
6795 if (!f
6796 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6797 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6798 {
6799 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6800 event.xconfigure.height);
6801 f = 0;
6802 }
6803 #endif
6804 if (f)
6805 {
6806 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6807 #ifndef USE_GTK
6808 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6809 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6810
6811 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6812 is called by the code that handles resizing
6813 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6814
6815 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6816 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6817 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6818 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6819 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6820 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6821 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6822 {
6823 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6824 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6825 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6826 }
6827
6828 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6829 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6830 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6831 #endif
6832
6833 #ifdef USE_GTK
6834 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6835 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6836 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6837 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6838 #endif
6839 {
6840 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6841 }
6842
6843 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6844 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6845 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6846 #endif
6847
6848 }
6849 goto OTHER;
6850
6851 case ButtonRelease:
6852 case ButtonPress:
6853 {
6854 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6855 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6856 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6857
6858 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6859 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6860 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6861
6862 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6863 && last_mouse_frame
6864 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6865 f = last_mouse_frame;
6866 else
6867 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6868
6869 #ifdef USE_GTK
6870 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6871 f = 0;
6872 #endif
6873 if (f)
6874 {
6875 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6876 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6877 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6878 {
6879 Lisp_Object window;
6880 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6881 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6882
6883 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6884 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6885
6886 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6887 {
6888 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6889 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6890 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6891 event.xbutton.state));
6892 }
6893 }
6894
6895 if (!tool_bar_p)
6896 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6897 if (! popup_activated ())
6898 #endif
6899 {
6900 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6901 {
6902 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6903 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6904 {
6905 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6906 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6907 }
6908 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6909 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6910 }
6911 else
6912 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6913 }
6914 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6915 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6916 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6917 }
6918 else
6919 {
6920 struct scroll_bar *bar
6921 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6922 event.xbutton.window);
6923
6924 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6925 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6926 scroll bars. */
6927 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6928 {
6929 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6930 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6931 }
6932 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6933 if (bar)
6934 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6935 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6936 }
6937
6938 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6939 {
6940 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6941 last_mouse_frame = f;
6942
6943 if (!tool_bar_p)
6944 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6945 }
6946 else
6947 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6948
6949 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6950 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6951 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6952 if (f != 0)
6953 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6954
6955 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6956 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6957 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6958 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6959 Instead, save it away
6960 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6961 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6962 if (! popup_activated ()
6963 #ifdef USE_GTK
6964 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6965 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6966 #endif
6967 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6968 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6969 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6970 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6971 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6972 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6973 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6974 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6975 {
6976 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6977 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6978 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6979 }
6980 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6981 {
6982 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6983 goto OTHER;
6984 }
6985 else
6986 goto OTHER;
6987 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6988 }
6989 break;
6990
6991 case CirculateNotify:
6992 goto OTHER;
6993
6994 case CirculateRequest:
6995 goto OTHER;
6996
6997 case VisibilityNotify:
6998 goto OTHER;
6999
7000 case MappingNotify:
7001 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
7002 local cache. */
7003 switch (event.xmapping.request)
7004 {
7005 case MappingModifier:
7006 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
7007 /* This is meant to fall through. */
7008 case MappingKeyboard:
7009 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
7010 }
7011 goto OTHER;
7012
7013 case DestroyNotify:
7014 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
7015 break;
7016
7017 default:
7018 OTHER:
7019 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7020 block_input ();
7021 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
7022 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
7023 unblock_input ();
7024 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7025 break;
7026 }
7027
7028 done:
7029 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
7030 {
7031 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7032 count++;
7033 }
7034
7035 if (do_help
7036 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
7037 {
7038 Lisp_Object frame;
7039
7040 if (f)
7041 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7042 else
7043 frame = Qnil;
7044
7045 if (do_help > 0)
7046 {
7047 any_help_event_p = 1;
7048 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
7049 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
7050 }
7051 else
7052 {
7053 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7054 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
7055 }
7056 count++;
7057 }
7058
7059 SAFE_FREE ();
7060 *eventptr = event;
7061 return count;
7062 }
7063
7064 #if defined USE_GTK || defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
7065
7066 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7067 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7068 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7069
7070 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7071 int
7072 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
7073 {
7074 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7075 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7076
7077 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7078
7079 if (dpyinfo)
7080 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7081
7082 return finish;
7083 }
7084 #endif
7085
7086
7087 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7088 Return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7089
7090 Return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7091 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7092 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7093 C chars). */
7094
7095 static int
7096 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7097 {
7098 int count = 0;
7099 int event_found = 0;
7100
7101 block_input ();
7102
7103 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7104 input_signal_count++;
7105
7106 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7107 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7108 {
7109 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7110 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7111 }
7112
7113 #ifndef USE_GTK
7114 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7115 {
7116 int finish;
7117 XEvent event;
7118
7119 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7120
7121 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7122 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7123 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7124 continue;
7125 #endif
7126 event_found = 1;
7127
7128 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7129 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7130
7131 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7132 goto out;
7133 }
7134
7135 out:;
7136
7137 #else /* USE_GTK */
7138
7139 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7140 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7141 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7142 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7143
7144 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7145 from all displays. */
7146
7147 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7148 {
7149 current_count = count;
7150 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7151
7152 gtk_main_iteration ();
7153
7154 count = current_count;
7155 current_count = -1;
7156 current_hold_quit = 0;
7157
7158 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7159 break;
7160 }
7161 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7162
7163 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7164 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7165 if (! event_found)
7166 {
7167 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7168 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7169 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7170 x_noop_count++;
7171 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7172 {
7173 x_noop_count=0;
7174
7175 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7176 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7177
7178 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7179
7180 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7181 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7182 }
7183 }
7184
7185 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7186 raise it now. */
7187 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7188 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7189 {
7190 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7191 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7192 }
7193
7194 unblock_input ();
7195
7196 return count;
7197 }
7198
7199
7200
7201 \f
7202 /***********************************************************************
7203 Text Cursor
7204 ***********************************************************************/
7205
7206 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7207 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7208
7209 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7210 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7211 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7212
7213 static void
7214 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7215 {
7216 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7217 XRectangle clip_rect;
7218 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7219
7220 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7221
7222 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7223 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7224 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7225 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7226 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7227
7228 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7229 }
7230
7231
7232 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7233
7234 static void
7235 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7236 {
7237 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7238 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7239 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7240 int x, y, wd, h;
7241 XGCValues xgcv;
7242 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7243 GC gc;
7244
7245 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7246 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7247 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7248 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7249 return;
7250
7251 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7252 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7253 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7254
7255 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7256 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7257 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7258 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7259 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7260 else
7261 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7262 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7263 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7264
7265 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7266 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7267 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7268 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7269 }
7270
7271
7272 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7273
7274 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7275 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7276 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7277 --gerd. */
7278
7279 static void
7280 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7281 {
7282 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7283 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7284
7285 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7286 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7287 and mini-buffer. */
7288 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7289 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7290 return;
7291
7292 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7293 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7294 the bar might not be in the window. */
7295 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7296 {
7297 struct glyph_row *r;
7298 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7299 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
7300 }
7301 else
7302 {
7303 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7304 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7305 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7306 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7307 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7308 XGCValues xgcv;
7309
7310 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7311 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7312 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7313 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7314 that the glyph is legible. */
7315 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7316 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7317 else
7318 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7319 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7320
7321 if (gc)
7322 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7323 else
7324 {
7325 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7326 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7327 }
7328
7329 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7330
7331 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7332 {
7333 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7334
7335 if (width < 0)
7336 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7337 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7338
7339 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7340
7341 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7342 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7343 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7344 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7345
7346 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7347 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7348 width, row->height);
7349 }
7350 else
7351 {
7352 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7353
7354 if (width < 0)
7355 width = row->height;
7356
7357 width = min (row->height, width);
7358
7359 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7360 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7361
7362 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7363 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7364 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7365 row->height - width),
7366 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7367 }
7368
7369 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7370 }
7371 }
7372
7373
7374 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7375
7376 static void
7377 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7378 {
7379 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7380 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7381 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7382 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7383 }
7384
7385
7386 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7387
7388 static void
7389 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7390 {
7391 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7392 x, y, width, height, False);
7393 #ifdef USE_GTK
7394 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7395 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7396 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7397 #endif
7398 }
7399
7400
7401 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7402
7403 static void
7404 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7405 {
7406 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7407
7408 if (on_p)
7409 {
7410 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7411 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7412
7413 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7414 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7415 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7416 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7417 {
7418 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7419 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7420 }
7421 else
7422 {
7423 switch (cursor_type)
7424 {
7425 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7426 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7427 break;
7428
7429 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7430 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7431 break;
7432
7433 case BAR_CURSOR:
7434 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7435 break;
7436
7437 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7438 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7439 break;
7440
7441 case NO_CURSOR:
7442 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7443 break;
7444
7445 default:
7446 emacs_abort ();
7447 }
7448 }
7449
7450 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7451 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7452 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7453 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7454 #endif
7455 }
7456
7457 #ifndef XFlush
7458 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7459 #endif
7460 }
7461
7462 \f
7463 /* Icons. */
7464
7465 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7466
7467 int
7468 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7469 {
7470 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id;
7471
7472 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7473 return 1;
7474
7475 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7476 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7477 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7478 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7479
7480 if (STRINGP (file))
7481 {
7482 #ifdef USE_GTK
7483 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7484 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7485 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7486 return 0;
7487 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7488 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7489 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7490 }
7491 else
7492 {
7493 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7494 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7495 {
7496 ptrdiff_t rc = -1;
7497
7498 #ifdef USE_GTK
7499
7500 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7501 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7502 return 0;
7503
7504 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7505
7506 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7507 if (rc != -1)
7508 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7509
7510 #endif
7511
7512 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7513 if (rc == -1)
7514 {
7515 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
7516 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7517 if (rc == -1)
7518 return 1;
7519
7520 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7521 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7522 }
7523 }
7524
7525 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7526 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7527 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7528 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7529 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7530
7531 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7532 }
7533
7534 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7535 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7536
7537 return 0;
7538 }
7539
7540
7541 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7542 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7543
7544 int
7545 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7546 {
7547 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7548 return 1;
7549
7550 {
7551 XTextProperty text;
7552 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7553 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7554 text.format = 8;
7555 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7556 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7557 }
7558
7559 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7560 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7561 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7562 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7563
7564 return 0;
7565 }
7566 \f
7567 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7568
7569 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7570 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7571
7572 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7573 be called from a signal handler.
7574 */
7575
7576 struct x_error_message_stack {
7577 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7578 Display *dpy;
7579 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7580 };
7581 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7582
7583 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7584 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7585 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7586
7587 static void
7588 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7589 {
7590 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
7591 x_error_message->string,
7592 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7593 }
7594
7595 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7596 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7597 operating on.
7598
7599 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7600 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7601 stored in *x_error_message.
7602
7603 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7604 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7605
7606 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7607
7608 void
7609 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7610 {
7611 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof *data);
7612
7613 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7614 XSync (dpy, False);
7615
7616 data->dpy = dpy;
7617 data->string[0] = 0;
7618 data->prev = x_error_message;
7619 x_error_message = data;
7620 }
7621
7622 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7623 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7624
7625 void
7626 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7627 {
7628 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7629
7630 block_input ();
7631
7632 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7633 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7634 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7635 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7636
7637 tmp = x_error_message;
7638 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7639 xfree (tmp);
7640 unblock_input ();
7641 }
7642
7643 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7644 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7645 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7646
7647 void
7648 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7649 {
7650 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7651 XSync (dpy, False);
7652
7653 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7654 {
7655 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7656 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7657 x_uncatch_errors ();
7658 error (format, string);
7659 }
7660 }
7661
7662 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7663 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7664
7665 int
7666 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7667 {
7668 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7669 XSync (dpy, False);
7670
7671 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7672 }
7673
7674 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7675
7676 void
7677 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7678 {
7679 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7680 }
7681
7682 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7683 * idea. --lorentey */
7684 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7685
7686 void
7687 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7688 {
7689 while (x_error_message)
7690 x_uncatch_errors ();
7691 }
7692 #endif
7693
7694 #if 0
7695 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7696 x_trace_wire (void)
7697 {
7698 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7699 }
7700 #endif /* ! 0 */
7701
7702 \f
7703 /************************************************************************
7704 Handling X errors
7705 ************************************************************************/
7706
7707 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7708
7709 static char *error_msg;
7710
7711 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7712 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7713
7714 static void
7715 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7716 {
7717 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7718 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7719 ptrdiff_t idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7720
7721 error_msg = alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7722 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7723
7724 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7725 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7726
7727 if (dpyinfo)
7728 {
7729 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7730 frame on it. */
7731 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7732 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7733 }
7734
7735 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7736 that are on the dead display. */
7737 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7738 {
7739 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7740 minibuf_frame
7741 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7742 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7743 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7744 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7745 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7746 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7747 }
7748
7749 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7750 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7751 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7752 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7753 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7754 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7755 {
7756 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7757 trying to find a replacement. */
7758 kset_default_minibuffer_frame (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Qt);
7759 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7760 }
7761
7762 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7763 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7764 if (dpyinfo)
7765 {
7766 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7767 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7768 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7769 #ifdef USE_GTK
7770 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7771 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7772 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7773 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7774 shut_down_emacs (0, Qnil);
7775 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7776 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7777 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7778 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7779 error_msg);
7780 emacs_abort ();
7781 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7782
7783 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7784 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7785
7786 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7787 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7788 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7789 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7790 emacs_abort ();
7791
7792 {
7793 Lisp_Object tmp;
7794 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7795 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7796 }
7797 }
7798
7799 if (terminal_list == 0)
7800 {
7801 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7802 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7803 /* NOTREACHED */
7804 }
7805
7806 totally_unblock_input ();
7807
7808 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
7809 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7810
7811 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
7812 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
7813
7814 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7815 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7816 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7817 error ("%s", error_msg);
7818 }
7819
7820 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7821 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7822 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7823
7824 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7825 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7826
7827 static int
7828 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7829 {
7830 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
7831 if (event->error_code == BadMatch
7832 && event->request_code == X_SetInputFocus
7833 && event->minor_code == 0)
7834 {
7835 return 0;
7836 }
7837 #endif
7838
7839 if (x_error_message)
7840 x_error_catcher (display, event);
7841 else
7842 x_error_quitter (display, event);
7843 return 0;
7844 }
7845
7846 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7847 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7848 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7849
7850 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7851
7852 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7853 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7854
7855 static void NO_INLINE
7856 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7857 {
7858 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7859
7860 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7861 or colors that are not defined. */
7862
7863 if (event->error_code == BadName)
7864 return;
7865
7866 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7867 original error handler. */
7868
7869 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7870 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7871 buf, event->request_code);
7872 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7873 }
7874
7875
7876 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7877 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7878 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7879
7880 static int
7881 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7882 {
7883 char buf[256];
7884
7885 snprintf (buf, sizeof buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'",
7886 DisplayString (display));
7887 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7888 return 0;
7889 }
7890 \f
7891 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7892
7893 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7894 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7895 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7896 FONT-OBJECT. */
7897
7898 Lisp_Object
7899 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7900 {
7901 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7902
7903 if (fontset < 0)
7904 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7905 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7906 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7907 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7908 do. */
7909 return font_object;
7910
7911 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7912 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7913 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7914 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->space_width;
7915 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7916
7917 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7918
7919 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7920 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7921 {
7922 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7923 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7924 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7925 }
7926 else
7927 {
7928 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7929 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7930 }
7931
7932 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7933 {
7934 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7935 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7936 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7937 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7938 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7939 }
7940
7941 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7942 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7943 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7944 {
7945 block_input ();
7946 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7947 unblock_input ();
7948 }
7949 #endif
7950
7951 return font_object;
7952 }
7953
7954 \f
7955 /***********************************************************************
7956 X Input Methods
7957 ***********************************************************************/
7958
7959 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7960
7961 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7962
7963 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7964 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7965 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7966
7967 static void
7968 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
7969 {
7970 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7971 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7972
7973 block_input ();
7974
7975 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7976 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7977 {
7978 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7979 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7980 {
7981 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7982 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7983 }
7984 }
7985
7986 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7987 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7988 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7989 unblock_input ();
7990 }
7991
7992 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7993
7994 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7995 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7996 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
7997 #endif
7998
7999 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8000 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8001
8002 static void
8003 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8004 {
8005 XIM xim;
8006
8007 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8008 if (use_xim)
8009 {
8010 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8011 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8012 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8013 emacs_class);
8014 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8015
8016 if (xim)
8017 {
8018 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8019 XIMCallback destroy;
8020 #endif
8021
8022 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8023 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8024
8025 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8026 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8027 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8028 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8029 #endif
8030 }
8031 }
8032
8033 else
8034 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8035 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8036 }
8037
8038
8039 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8040
8041 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8042 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8043 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8044 when the callback was registered. */
8045
8046 static void
8047 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8048 {
8049 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8050 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8051
8052 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8053 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8054 return;
8055
8056 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8057
8058 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8059 as they have no XIC. */
8060 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8061 {
8062 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8063
8064 block_input ();
8065 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8066 {
8067 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8068
8069 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8070 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8071 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8072 {
8073 create_frame_xic (f);
8074 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8075 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8076 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8077 {
8078 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8079 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8080 }
8081 }
8082 }
8083
8084 unblock_input ();
8085 }
8086 }
8087
8088 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8089
8090
8091 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8092 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8093 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8094 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8095
8096 static void
8097 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8098 {
8099 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8100 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8101 if (use_xim)
8102 {
8103 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8104 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = xmalloc (sizeof *xim_inst);
8105 ptrdiff_t len;
8106
8107 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8108 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8109 len = strlen (resource_name);
8110 xim_inst->resource_name = xmalloc (len + 1);
8111 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8112 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8113 resource_name, emacs_class,
8114 xim_instantiate_callback,
8115 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8116 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8117 least, hence the configure test. */
8118 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8119 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8120 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8121 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8122 }
8123 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8124 }
8125
8126
8127 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8128
8129 static void
8130 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8131 {
8132 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8133 if (use_xim)
8134 {
8135 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8136 if (dpyinfo->display)
8137 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8138 NULL, emacs_class,
8139 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8140 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8141 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8142 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8143 if (dpyinfo->display)
8144 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8145 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8146 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8147 }
8148 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8149 }
8150
8151 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8152
8153
8154 \f
8155 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8156 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8157
8158 static void
8159 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8160 {
8161 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8162
8163 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8164 is already for the top-left corner. */
8165 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8166 return;
8167
8168 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8169 position that fits on the screen. */
8170 if (flags & XNegative)
8171 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8172 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8173
8174 {
8175 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8176
8177 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8178 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8179 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8180
8181 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8182 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8183 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8184 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8185 is right, though.
8186
8187 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8188 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8189
8190 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8191 #endif
8192
8193 if (flags & YNegative)
8194 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8195 - height + f->top_pos;
8196 }
8197
8198 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8199 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8200 so the flags should correspond. */
8201 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8202 }
8203
8204 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8205 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8206 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8207 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8208 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8209
8210 void
8211 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8212 {
8213 int modified_top, modified_left;
8214
8215 if (change_gravity > 0)
8216 {
8217 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8218 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8219
8220 f->top_pos = yoff;
8221 f->left_pos = xoff;
8222 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8223 if (xoff < 0)
8224 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8225 if (yoff < 0)
8226 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8227 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8228 }
8229 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8230
8231 block_input ();
8232 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8233
8234 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8235 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8236
8237 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8238 {
8239 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8240 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8241 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8242 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8243 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8244 }
8245
8246 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8247 modified_left, modified_top);
8248
8249 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8250 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8251 ? 1 : 0);
8252
8253 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8254 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8255 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8256 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8257 of the frame.
8258
8259 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8260 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8261 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8262
8263 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8264 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8265 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8266 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8267 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8268 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8269
8270 unblock_input ();
8271 }
8272
8273 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8274 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8275 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8276 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8277 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8278
8279 static int
8280 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8281 {
8282 Atom actual_type;
8283 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8284 int i, rc, actual_format;
8285 Window wmcheck_window;
8286 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8287 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8288 long max_len = 65536;
8289 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8290 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8291 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8292
8293 block_input ();
8294
8295 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8296 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8297 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8298 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8299 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8300 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8301
8302 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8303 {
8304 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8305 x_uncatch_errors ();
8306 unblock_input ();
8307 return 0;
8308 }
8309
8310 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8311 XFree (tmp_data);
8312
8313 /* Check if window exists. */
8314 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8315 x_sync (f);
8316 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8317 {
8318 x_uncatch_errors ();
8319 unblock_input ();
8320 return 0;
8321 }
8322
8323 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8324 {
8325 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8326 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8327 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8328 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8329 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8330 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8331
8332 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8333 tmp_data = NULL;
8334 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8335 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8336 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8337 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8338 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8339
8340 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8341 {
8342 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8343 x_uncatch_errors ();
8344 unblock_input ();
8345 return 0;
8346 }
8347
8348 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8349 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8350 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8351 }
8352
8353 rc = 0;
8354
8355 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8356 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8357
8358 x_uncatch_errors ();
8359 unblock_input ();
8360
8361 return rc;
8362 }
8363
8364 static void
8365 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8366 {
8367 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8368
8369 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8370 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8371 make_number (32),
8372 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8373 Fcons
8374 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8375 Fcons
8376 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8377 value != 0
8378 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8379 : Qnil)));
8380 }
8381
8382 void
8383 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8384 {
8385 Lisp_Object frame;
8386 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8387
8388 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8389
8390 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8391 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8392 }
8393
8394 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8395 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8396 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not.
8397
8398 Return non-zero if we are not hidden, zero if we are. */
8399
8400 static int
8401 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8402 Window window,
8403 int *size_state,
8404 int *sticky)
8405 {
8406 Atom actual_type;
8407 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8408 int i, rc, actual_format, is_hidden = 0;
8409 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8410 long max_len = 65536;
8411 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8412 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8413 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8414
8415 *sticky = 0;
8416 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8417
8418 block_input ();
8419 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8420 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8421 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8422 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8423 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8424
8425 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8426 {
8427 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8428 x_uncatch_errors ();
8429 unblock_input ();
8430 return ! f->iconified;
8431 }
8432
8433 x_uncatch_errors ();
8434
8435 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8436 {
8437 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8438 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden)
8439 {
8440 is_hidden = 1;
8441 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 1;
8442 }
8443 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8444 {
8445 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8446 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8447 else
8448 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8449 }
8450 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8451 {
8452 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8453 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8454 else
8455 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8456 }
8457 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8458 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8459 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8460 *sticky = 1;
8461 }
8462
8463 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8464 unblock_input ();
8465 return ! is_hidden;
8466 }
8467
8468 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8469
8470 static int
8471 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8472 {
8473 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8474 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8475 int cur, dummy;
8476
8477 (void)get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8478
8479 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8480 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8481 if (!have_net_atom)
8482 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8483
8484 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8485 {
8486 Lisp_Object frame;
8487
8488 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8489
8490 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8491 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8492 are sent at once. */
8493 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8494 {
8495 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8496 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8497 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8498 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8499 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8500 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8501 break;
8502 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8503 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8504 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8505 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8506 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8507 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8508 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8509 break;
8510 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8511 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8512 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8513 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8514 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8515 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8516 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8517 break;
8518 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8519 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8520 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8521 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8522 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8523 break;
8524 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8525 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8526 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8527 else
8528 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8529 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8530 }
8531
8532 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8533
8534 }
8535
8536 return have_net_atom;
8537 }
8538
8539 static void
8540 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8541 {
8542 if (f->async_visible)
8543 {
8544 block_input ();
8545 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8546 x_sync (f);
8547 unblock_input ();
8548 }
8549 }
8550
8551
8552 static int
8553 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8554 {
8555 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8556 Lisp_Object lval;
8557 int sticky = 0;
8558 int not_hidden = get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8559
8560 lval = Qnil;
8561 switch (value)
8562 {
8563 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8564 lval = Qfullwidth;
8565 break;
8566 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8567 lval = Qfullheight;
8568 break;
8569 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8570 lval = Qfullboth;
8571 break;
8572 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8573 lval = Qmaximized;
8574 break;
8575 }
8576
8577 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8578 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8579
8580 return not_hidden;
8581 }
8582
8583 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8584 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8585 static void
8586 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8587 {
8588 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8589 return;
8590
8591 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8592 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8593
8594 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8595 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8596 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8597
8598 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8599 {
8600 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8601 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8602
8603 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8604 {
8605 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8606 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8607 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8608 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8609 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8610 break;
8611 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8612 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8613 break;
8614 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8615 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8616 }
8617
8618 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8619 width, height);
8620 }
8621 }
8622
8623 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8624 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8625 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8626 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8627 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8628 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8629 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8630
8631 static void
8632 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8633 {
8634 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8635
8636 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8637 window manager window around the frame. */
8638
8639 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8640
8641 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8642 {
8643 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8644
8645 int adjusted_left;
8646 int adjusted_top;
8647
8648 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8649 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8650 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8651
8652 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8653
8654 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8655 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8656
8657 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8658 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8659
8660 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8661 }
8662 else
8663 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8664 frame's position. */
8665
8666 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8667 }
8668
8669
8670 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8671 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8672 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8673 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8674 of an exact comparison. */
8675
8676 static void
8677 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8678 {
8679 int count = 0;
8680
8681 while (count++ < 50)
8682 {
8683 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8684
8685 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8686 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8687 loop. */
8688
8689 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8690 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8691
8692 if (fuzzy)
8693 {
8694 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8695 pixels. */
8696
8697 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8698 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8699 return;
8700 }
8701 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8702 return;
8703 }
8704
8705 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8706 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8707
8708 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8709 }
8710
8711
8712 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8713 void
8714 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8715 {
8716 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8717
8718 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8719 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8720 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8721
8722 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8723 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8724
8725 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticeable.
8726 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8727 tmo = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
8728 tmo_at = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), tmo);
8729
8730 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8731 {
8732 pending_signals = 1;
8733 totally_unblock_input ();
8734 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8735 block_input ();
8736 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8737
8738 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8739 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8740
8741 time_now = current_emacs_time ();
8742 if (EMACS_TIME_LT (tmo_at, time_now))
8743 break;
8744
8745 tmo = sub_emacs_time (tmo_at, time_now);
8746 if (pselect (fd + 1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo, NULL) == 0)
8747 break; /* Timeout */
8748 }
8749 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8750 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8751 }
8752
8753
8754 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8755 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8756 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8757 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8758
8759 static void
8760 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8761 {
8762 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8763
8764 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8765 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8766 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8767 ? 0
8768 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8769
8770 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8771
8772 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8773 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8774 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8775 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8776
8777 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8778 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8779 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8780 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8781
8782
8783 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8784 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8785 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8786 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8787 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8788
8789 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8790 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8791 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8792 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8793
8794 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8795 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8796 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8797 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8798 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8799
8800 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8801 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8802
8803 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8804 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8805 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8806 if (f->async_visible)
8807 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8808 else
8809 {
8810 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8811 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8812 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8813 x_sync (f);
8814 }
8815 }
8816
8817
8818 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8819 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8820 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8821 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8822
8823 void
8824 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8825 {
8826 block_input ();
8827
8828 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8829 {
8830 int r, c;
8831
8832 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8833 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8834 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8835 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8836 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8837 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8838 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8839 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8840 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8841 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8842 is however. */
8843 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8844 #endif
8845 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8846 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8847 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8848 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8849 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8850 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8851 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8852 }
8853
8854 #ifdef USE_GTK
8855 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8856 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8857 else
8858 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8859 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8860
8861 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8862
8863 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8864
8865 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8866 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8867
8868 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8869 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8870 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8871 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8872 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8873
8874 unblock_input ();
8875 }
8876 \f
8877 /* Mouse warping. */
8878
8879 void
8880 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8881 {
8882 int pix_x, pix_y;
8883
8884 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8885 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8886
8887 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8888 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8889
8890 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8891 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8892
8893 block_input ();
8894
8895 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8896 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8897 unblock_input ();
8898 }
8899
8900 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8901
8902 void
8903 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8904 {
8905 block_input ();
8906
8907 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8908 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8909 unblock_input ();
8910 }
8911 \f
8912 /* Raise frame F. */
8913
8914 void
8915 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8916 {
8917 block_input ();
8918 if (f->async_visible)
8919 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8920
8921 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8922 unblock_input ();
8923 }
8924
8925 /* Lower frame F. */
8926
8927 static void
8928 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
8929 {
8930 if (f->async_visible)
8931 {
8932 block_input ();
8933 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8934 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8935 unblock_input ();
8936 }
8937 }
8938
8939 /* Request focus with XEmbed */
8940
8941 void
8942 xembed_request_focus (FRAME_PTR f)
8943 {
8944 /* See XEmbed Protocol Specification at
8945 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/xembed-spec */
8946 if (f->async_visible)
8947 xembed_send_message (f, CurrentTime,
8948 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
8949 }
8950
8951 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8952
8953 void
8954 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
8955 {
8956 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8957 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8958
8959 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8960 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
8961 {
8962 Lisp_Object frame;
8963 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8964 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8965 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
8966 make_number (32),
8967 Fcons (make_number (1),
8968 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
8969 Qnil)));
8970 }
8971 }
8972
8973 static void
8974 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
8975 {
8976 if (raise_flag)
8977 x_raise_frame (f);
8978 else
8979 x_lower_frame (f);
8980 }
8981 \f
8982 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8983
8984 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
8985
8986 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8987
8988 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
8989
8990 static void
8991 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
8992 {
8993 unsigned long data[2];
8994 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8995
8996 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
8997 data[1] = flags;
8998
8999 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9000 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
9001 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
9002 }
9003 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
9004
9005 static void
9006 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
9007 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
9008 {
9009 XEvent event;
9010
9011 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9012 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9013 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9014 event.xclient.format = 32;
9015 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
9016 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
9017 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9018 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9019 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9020
9021 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9022 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9023 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9024 }
9025 \f
9026 /* Change of visibility. */
9027
9028 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9029 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9030 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9031 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9032 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9033 finishes with it. */
9034
9035 void
9036 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9037 {
9038 Lisp_Object type;
9039 int original_top, original_left;
9040 int retry_count = 2;
9041
9042 retry:
9043
9044 block_input ();
9045
9046 type = x_icon_type (f);
9047 if (!NILP (type))
9048 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9049
9050 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9051 {
9052 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9053 call x_set_offset a second time
9054 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9055 before the window gets really visible. */
9056 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9057 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9058 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9059 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9060
9061 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9062
9063 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9064 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9065 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9066 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9067 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9068 else
9069 {
9070 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9071 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9072 }
9073 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9074 #ifdef USE_GTK
9075 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9076 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9077 #else
9078 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9079 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9080 else
9081 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9082 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9083 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9084 }
9085
9086 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9087
9088 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9089 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9090 so that incoming events are handled. */
9091 {
9092 Lisp_Object frame;
9093 int count;
9094 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9095 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9096 will set it when they are handled. */
9097 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9098
9099 original_left = f->left_pos;
9100 original_top = f->top_pos;
9101
9102 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9103 unblock_input ();
9104
9105 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9106
9107 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9108 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9109 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9110 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9111
9112 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9113 because the window manager may choose the position
9114 and we don't want to override it. */
9115
9116 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9117 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9118 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9119 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9120 && previously_visible)
9121 {
9122 Drawable rootw;
9123 int x, y;
9124 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9125
9126 block_input ();
9127
9128 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9129 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9130 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9131 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9132 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9133 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9134 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9135 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9136 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9137
9138 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9139 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9140 original_left, original_top);
9141
9142 unblock_input ();
9143 }
9144
9145 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9146
9147 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9148 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9149 MapNotify at all.. */
9150 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9151 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9152 {
9153 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9154 x_sync (f);
9155
9156 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9157 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9158 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9159 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9160 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9161 probably a bug. */
9162 if (input_polling_used ())
9163 {
9164 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9165 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9166 handler reset it. */
9167 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9168 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9169 poll_for_input_1 ();
9170 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9171 }
9172
9173 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9174 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9175 }
9176
9177 /* 2000-09-28: In
9178
9179 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9180 (iconify-frame f)
9181 (raise-frame f))
9182
9183 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9184 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9185 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9186 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9187
9188 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count != 0)
9189 goto retry;
9190 }
9191 }
9192
9193 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9194
9195 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9196
9197 void
9198 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9199 {
9200 Window window;
9201
9202 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9203 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9204
9205 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9206 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9207 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9208
9209 block_input ();
9210
9211 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9212 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9213 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9214 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9215 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9216 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9217
9218 #ifdef USE_GTK
9219 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9220 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9221 else
9222 #else
9223 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9224 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9225 else
9226 #endif
9227 {
9228
9229 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9230 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9231 {
9232 unblock_input ();
9233 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9234 }
9235 }
9236
9237 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9238 just by the event that we get from the server.
9239 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9240 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9241 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9242 f->visible = 0;
9243 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9244 f->async_visible = 0;
9245 f->async_iconified = 0;
9246
9247 x_sync (f);
9248
9249 unblock_input ();
9250 }
9251
9252 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9253
9254 void
9255 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9256 {
9257 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9258 int result;
9259 #endif
9260 Lisp_Object type;
9261
9262 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9263 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9264 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9265
9266 if (f->async_iconified)
9267 return;
9268
9269 block_input ();
9270
9271 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9272
9273 type = x_icon_type (f);
9274 if (!NILP (type))
9275 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9276
9277 #if defined (USE_GTK)
9278 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9279 {
9280 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9281 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9282
9283 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9284 f->iconified = 1;
9285 f->visible = 1;
9286 f->async_iconified = 1;
9287 f->async_visible = 0;
9288 unblock_input ();
9289 return;
9290 }
9291 #endif
9292
9293 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9294
9295 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9296 {
9297 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9298 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9299 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9300 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9301 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9302 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9303 so we have to record it here. */
9304 f->iconified = 1;
9305 f->visible = 1;
9306 f->async_iconified = 1;
9307 f->async_visible = 0;
9308 unblock_input ();
9309 return;
9310 }
9311
9312 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9313 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9314 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9315 unblock_input ();
9316
9317 if (!result)
9318 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9319
9320 f->async_iconified = 1;
9321 f->async_visible = 0;
9322
9323
9324 block_input ();
9325 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9326 unblock_input ();
9327 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9328
9329 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9330 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9331 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9332 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9333 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9334 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9335
9336 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9337 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9338
9339 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9340 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9341 {
9342 XEvent msg;
9343
9344 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9345 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9346 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9347 msg.xclient.format = 32;
9348 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9349
9350 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9351 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9352 False,
9353 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9354 &msg))
9355 {
9356 unblock_input ();
9357 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9358 }
9359 }
9360
9361 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9362 IconicState. */
9363 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9364
9365 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9366 {
9367 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9368 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9369 }
9370
9371 f->async_iconified = 1;
9372 f->async_visible = 0;
9373
9374 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9375 unblock_input ();
9376 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9377 }
9378
9379 \f
9380 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9381
9382 void
9383 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9384 {
9385 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9386 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9387 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9388 Lisp_Object bar;
9389 struct scroll_bar *b;
9390 #endif
9391
9392 block_input ();
9393
9394 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9395 commands to the X server. */
9396 if (dpyinfo->display)
9397 {
9398 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9399 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9400 face. */
9401 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9402 free_frame_faces (f);
9403
9404 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9405 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9406
9407 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9408 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9409 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9410 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9411 toolkit scroll bars. */
9412 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9413 {
9414 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9415 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9416 }
9417 #endif
9418
9419 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9420 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9421 free_frame_xic (f);
9422 #endif
9423
9424 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9425 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9426 {
9427 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9428 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9429 }
9430 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9431 we are using a toolkit. */
9432 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9433 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9434
9435 free_frame_menubar (f);
9436 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9437
9438 #ifdef USE_GTK
9439 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9440 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9441
9442 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9443 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9444 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9445
9446 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9447 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9448 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9449 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9450 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9451 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9452
9453 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9454 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9455 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9456 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9457 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9458 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9459 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9460 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9461 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9462 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9463 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9464 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9465 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9466 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9467 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9468
9469 x_free_gcs (f);
9470 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9471 }
9472
9473 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9474 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9475 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9476
9477 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9478 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9479 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9480 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9481 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9482 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9483
9484 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9485 {
9486 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9487 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9488 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9489 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9490 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9491 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9492 }
9493
9494 unblock_input ();
9495 }
9496
9497
9498 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9499
9500 static void
9501 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9502 {
9503 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9504
9505 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9506 commands to the X server. */
9507 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9508 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9509
9510 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9511 }
9512
9513 \f
9514 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9515
9516 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9517 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9518 that the window now has.
9519 If USER_POSITION, set the USPosition
9520 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9521 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c. */
9522
9523 #ifndef USE_GTK
9524 void
9525 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, bool user_position)
9526 {
9527 XSizeHints size_hints;
9528 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9529
9530 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9531 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9532 {
9533 widget_update_wm_size_hints (f->output_data.x->widget);
9534 return;
9535 }
9536 #endif
9537
9538 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9539 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9540
9541 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9542 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9543
9544 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9545 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9546
9547 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9548 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9549 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9550 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9551 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9552 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9553
9554 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9555 {
9556 int base_width, base_height;
9557 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9558
9559 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9560 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9561
9562 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9563
9564 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9565 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9566 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9567 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9568 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9569
9570 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9571 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9572 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9573
9574 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9575 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9576 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9577 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9578 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9579 }
9580
9581 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9582 if (flags)
9583 {
9584 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9585 goto no_read;
9586 }
9587
9588 {
9589 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9590 long supplied_return;
9591 int value;
9592
9593 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9594 &supplied_return);
9595
9596 if (flags)
9597 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9598 else
9599 {
9600 if (value == 0)
9601 hints.flags = 0;
9602 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9603 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9604 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9605 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9606 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9607 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9608 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9609 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9610 }
9611 }
9612
9613 no_read:
9614
9615 #ifdef PWinGravity
9616 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9617 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9618
9619 if (user_position)
9620 {
9621 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9622 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9623 }
9624 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9625
9626 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9627 }
9628 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9629
9630 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9631
9632 static void
9633 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9634 {
9635 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9636 Arg al[1];
9637
9638 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9639 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9640 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9641 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9642
9643 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9644 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9645
9646 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9647 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9648 }
9649
9650 static void
9651 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id)
9652 {
9653 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9654
9655 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9656 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9657 #endif
9658
9659 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9660 {
9661 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9662 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9663 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9664 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9665 }
9666 else
9667 {
9668 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9669 pixmap. */
9670 return;
9671 }
9672
9673
9674 #ifdef USE_GTK
9675 {
9676 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9677 return;
9678 }
9679
9680 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9681
9682 {
9683 Arg al[1];
9684 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9685 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9686 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9687 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9688 }
9689
9690 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9691
9692 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9693 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9694
9695 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9696 }
9697
9698 void
9699 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9700 {
9701 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9702
9703 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9704 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9705 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9706
9707 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9708 }
9709
9710 \f
9711 /***********************************************************************
9712 Fonts
9713 ***********************************************************************/
9714
9715 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
9716
9717 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9718 font table. */
9719
9720 static void
9721 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9722 {
9723 eassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9724 if (font->driver->check)
9725 eassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9726 }
9727
9728 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
9729
9730 \f
9731 /***********************************************************************
9732 Initialization
9733 ***********************************************************************/
9734
9735 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9736 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9737 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9738 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9739
9740 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9741 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9742 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9743
9744 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9745 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9746 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9747 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9748 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9749 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9750 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9751 };
9752
9753 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9754
9755 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9756
9757 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9758
9759 static int x_initialized;
9760
9761 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9762 the screen number from the server number. */
9763 static int
9764 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9765 {
9766 int seen_colon = 0;
9767 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
9768 ptrdiff_t system_name_length = SBYTES (Vsystem_name);
9769 ptrdiff_t length_until_period = 0;
9770
9771 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9772 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9773 length_until_period++;
9774
9775 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9776 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9777 name1 += 4;
9778 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9779 name2 += 4;
9780 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9781 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9782 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9783 name1 += system_name_length;
9784 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9785 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9786 name2 += system_name_length;
9787 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9788 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9789 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9790 name1 += length_until_period;
9791 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9792 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9793 name2 += length_until_period;
9794
9795 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9796 {
9797 if (*name1 == ':')
9798 seen_colon = 1;
9799 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9800 return 1;
9801 }
9802 return (seen_colon
9803 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9804 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9805 }
9806
9807 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9808 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9809 to 5. */
9810 static void
9811 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9812 {
9813 int nr = 0;
9814 int off = 0;
9815
9816 while (!(mask & 1))
9817 {
9818 off++;
9819 mask >>= 1;
9820 }
9821
9822 while (mask & 1)
9823 {
9824 nr++;
9825 mask >>= 1;
9826 }
9827
9828 *offset = off;
9829 *bits = nr;
9830 }
9831
9832 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9833 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9834
9835 int
9836 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9837 {
9838 int dpy_ok = 1;
9839 Display *dpy;
9840
9841 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9842 if (dpy)
9843 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9844 else
9845 dpy_ok = 0;
9846 return dpy_ok;
9847 }
9848
9849 #ifdef USE_GTK
9850 static void
9851 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
9852 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
9853 {
9854 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
9855 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
9856 }
9857 #endif
9858
9859 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9860 the structure that describes the open display.
9861 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9862
9863 struct x_display_info *
9864 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9865 {
9866 int connection;
9867 Display *dpy;
9868 struct terminal *terminal;
9869 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9870 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9871 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9872 ptrdiff_t lim;
9873
9874 block_input ();
9875
9876 if (!x_initialized)
9877 {
9878 x_initialize ();
9879 ++x_initialized;
9880 }
9881
9882 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
9883 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
9884
9885 #ifdef USE_GTK
9886 {
9887 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9888 int argc;
9889 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9890 char **argv2 = argv;
9891 guint id;
9892
9893 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9894 {
9895 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9896 }
9897 else
9898 {
9899 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9900 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9901
9902 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9903 argv[argc] = 0;
9904
9905 argc = 0;
9906 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9907
9908 if (! NILP (display_name))
9909 {
9910 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9911 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
9912 }
9913
9914 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9915 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9916
9917 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9918
9919 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
9920 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
9921 {
9922 static char fix_events[] = "GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1";
9923 putenv (fix_events);
9924 }
9925
9926 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9927 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9928 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9929 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
9930
9931 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function.
9932 Call before gtk_init so Gtk+ event filters comes after our. */
9933 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9934
9935 /* gtk_init does set_locale. Fix locale before and after. */
9936 fixup_locale ();
9937 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
9938 fixup_locale ();
9939
9940 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
9941
9942 xg_initialize ();
9943
9944 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
9945
9946 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION <= 2 && GTK_MINOR_VERSION <= 90
9947 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9948 {
9949 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9950 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
9951
9952 s = build_string (file);
9953 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
9954
9955 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
9956 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
9957 }
9958 #endif
9959
9960 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
9961 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
9962 }
9963 }
9964 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9965 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9966 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9967 errors with X11R5:
9968 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9969 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9970 So let's not use it until R6. */
9971 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9972 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
9973 #endif
9974
9975 {
9976 int argc = 0;
9977 char *argv[3];
9978
9979 argv[0] = "";
9980 argc = 1;
9981 if (xrm_option)
9982 {
9983 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
9984 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
9985 }
9986 turn_on_atimers (0);
9987 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
9988 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
9989 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
9990 &argc, argv);
9991 turn_on_atimers (1);
9992
9993 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9994 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
9995 fixup_locale ();
9996 #endif
9997 }
9998
9999 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10000 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10001 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
10002 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10003 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10004
10005 /* Detect failure. */
10006 if (dpy == 0)
10007 {
10008 unblock_input ();
10009 return 0;
10010 }
10011
10012 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10013
10014 dpyinfo = xzalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo);
10015 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
10016
10017 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
10018
10019 {
10020 struct x_display_info *share;
10021 Lisp_Object tail;
10022
10023 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10024 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10025 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10026 SSDATA (display_name)))
10027 break;
10028 if (share)
10029 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10030 else
10031 {
10032 terminal->kboard = xmalloc (sizeof *terminal->kboard);
10033 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
10034 kset_window_system (terminal->kboard, Qx);
10035
10036 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
10037 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
10038 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
10039 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10040 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10041
10042 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10043 {
10044 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10045
10046 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10047 list of terminals. */
10048 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10049 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10050 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10051 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10052
10053 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10054 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10055 unblock_input ();
10056 kset_system_key_alist
10057 (terminal->kboard,
10058 call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10059 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string));
10060 block_input ();
10061 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10062 terminal_list = terminal;
10063 UNGCPRO;
10064 }
10065
10066 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10067 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10068 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10069 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10070 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10071 }
10072 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10073 }
10074
10075 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10076 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10077 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10078
10079 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10080 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10081 x_display_name_list);
10082 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10083
10084 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10085
10086 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10087 terminal->name = xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10088 memcpy (terminal->name, SSDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10089 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10090
10091 #if 0
10092 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10093 #endif /* ! 0 */
10094
10095 lim = min (PTRDIFF_MAX, SIZE_MAX) - sizeof "@";
10096 if (lim - SBYTES (Vinvocation_name) < SBYTES (Vsystem_name))
10097 memory_full (SIZE_MAX);
10098 dpyinfo->x_id_name = xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10099 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name) + 2);
10100 strcat (strcat (strcpy (dpyinfo->x_id_name, SSDATA (Vinvocation_name)), "@"),
10101 SSDATA (Vsystem_name));
10102
10103 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10104 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10105
10106 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10107 #ifdef USE_GTK
10108 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10109 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10110 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10111
10112 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10113 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10114
10115 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10116 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10117 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10118 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10119 #else
10120 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10121 #endif
10122 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10123 all versions. */
10124 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10125
10126 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10127 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10128 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10129 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10130 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10131 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10132 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10133 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10134 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10135 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10136 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10137 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10138 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10139 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10140 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10141 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10142 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10143 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10144 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10145 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10146 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10147 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10148 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10149 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10150 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10151 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10152 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10153
10154 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10155 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10156 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10157
10158 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10159 {
10160 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10161 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10162 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10163 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10164 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10165 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10166 }
10167
10168 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10169 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10170 {
10171 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10172 {
10173 Lisp_Object value;
10174 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10175 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10176 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10177 Qnil, Qnil);
10178 if (STRINGP (value)
10179 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10180 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10181 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10182 }
10183 }
10184 else
10185 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10186 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10187
10188 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10189 {
10190 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10191 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10192 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10193 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10194 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10195 for example). */
10196 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10197 double d;
10198 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10199 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10200 }
10201 #endif
10202
10203 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10204 {
10205 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10206 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10207 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10208 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10209 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10210 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10211 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10212 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10213 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10214 }
10215
10216 {
10217 const struct
10218 {
10219 const char *name;
10220 Atom *atom;
10221 } atom_refs[] = {
10222 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols },
10223 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus },
10224 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself },
10225 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window },
10226 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state },
10227 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied },
10228 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved },
10229 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader },
10230 { "Editres", &dpyinfo->Xatom_editres },
10231 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD },
10232 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP },
10233 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT },
10234 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT },
10235 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING },
10236 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE },
10237 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE },
10238 { "INCR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR },
10239 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP },
10240 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS },
10241 { "NULL", &dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL },
10242 { "ATOM", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM },
10243 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR },
10244 { "CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER },
10245 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO },
10246 /* For properties of font. */
10247 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE },
10248 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH },
10249 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET },
10250 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE },
10251 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT },
10252 /* Ghostscript support. */
10253 { "DONE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE },
10254 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE },
10255 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar },
10256 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED },
10257 /* EWMH */
10258 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state },
10259 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen },
10260 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10261 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz },
10262 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10263 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert },
10264 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky },
10265 { "_NET_WM_STATE_HIDDEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden },
10266 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type },
10267 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10268 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip },
10269 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name },
10270 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name },
10271 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported },
10272 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check },
10273 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity },
10274 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window },
10275 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_frame_extents },
10276 /* Session management */
10277 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID },
10278 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_prop },
10279 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_mgr },
10280 };
10281
10282 int i;
10283 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10284 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10285 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10286 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atoms_return);
10287 char **atom_names = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atom_names);
10288 static char const xsettings_fmt[] = "_XSETTINGS_S%d";
10289 char xsettings_atom_name[sizeof xsettings_fmt - 2
10290 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int)];
10291
10292 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10293 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10294
10295 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10296 sprintf (xsettings_atom_name, xsettings_fmt,
10297 XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10298 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10299
10300 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10301 False, atoms_return);
10302
10303 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10304 *atom_refs[i].atom = atoms_return[i];
10305
10306 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10307 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10308
10309 xfree (atom_names);
10310 xfree (atoms_return);
10311 }
10312
10313 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10314 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10315 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms
10316 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10317
10318 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10319 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10320 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10321
10322 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10323 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10324 dpyinfo->gray
10325 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10326 gray_bits, gray_width, gray_height,
10327 1, 0, 1);
10328
10329 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10330 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10331 #endif
10332
10333 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10334
10335 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10336 if (connection != 0)
10337 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10338
10339 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10340 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10341 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10342
10343 if (interrupt_input)
10344 init_sigio (connection);
10345
10346 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10347 {
10348 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10349 Font font;
10350
10351 dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10352 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10353 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10354 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10355 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10356 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10357 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10358 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10359 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10360 emacs_abort ();
10361 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10362 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10363 x_uncatch_errors ();
10364 }
10365 #endif
10366
10367 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10368 for debugging X code. */
10369 {
10370 Lisp_Object value;
10371 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10372 build_string ("synchronous"),
10373 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10374 Qnil, Qnil);
10375 if (STRINGP (value)
10376 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10377 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10378 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10379 }
10380
10381 {
10382 Lisp_Object value;
10383 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10384 build_string ("useXIM"),
10385 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10386 Qnil, Qnil);
10387 #ifdef USE_XIM
10388 if (STRINGP (value)
10389 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
10390 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
10391 use_xim = 0;
10392 #else
10393 if (STRINGP (value)
10394 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10395 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10396 use_xim = 1;
10397 #endif
10398 }
10399
10400 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10401 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10402 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10403 tty. */
10404 if (terminal->id == 1)
10405 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10406 #endif
10407
10408 unblock_input ();
10409
10410 return dpyinfo;
10411 }
10412 \f
10413 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10414 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10415
10416 static void
10417 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10418 {
10419 struct terminal *t;
10420
10421 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10422 X display. */
10423 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10424 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10425 {
10426 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10427 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10428 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10429 x_session_close ();
10430 #endif
10431 delete_terminal (t);
10432 break;
10433 }
10434
10435 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10436
10437 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10438 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10439 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10440 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10441 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10442 else
10443 {
10444 Lisp_Object tail;
10445
10446 tail = x_display_name_list;
10447 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10448 {
10449 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10450 {
10451 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10452 break;
10453 }
10454 tail = XCDR (tail);
10455 }
10456 }
10457
10458 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10459 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10460
10461 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10462 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10463 else
10464 {
10465 struct x_display_info *tail;
10466
10467 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10468 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10469 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10470 }
10471
10472 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10473 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10474 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10475 xfree (dpyinfo);
10476 }
10477
10478 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10479
10480 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10481 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10482 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10483 that slows us down. */
10484
10485 static void
10486 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10487 {
10488 block_input ();
10489 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10490 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10491 {
10492 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10493 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10494 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10495 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10496 }
10497 unblock_input ();
10498 }
10499
10500 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10501 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10502 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10503 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10504 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10505 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10506 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10507
10508 void
10509 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10510 {
10511 block_input ();
10512 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10513 {
10514 EMACS_TIME interval = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
10515 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10516 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10517 }
10518 unblock_input ();
10519 }
10520
10521 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10522
10523 \f
10524 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10525
10526 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10527 {
10528 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10529 x_produce_glyphs,
10530 x_write_glyphs,
10531 x_insert_glyphs,
10532 x_clear_end_of_line,
10533 x_scroll_run,
10534 x_after_update_window_line,
10535 x_update_window_begin,
10536 x_update_window_end,
10537 x_cursor_to,
10538 x_flush,
10539 #ifdef XFlush
10540 x_flush,
10541 #else
10542 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10543 #endif
10544 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10545 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10546 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10547 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10548 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10549 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10550 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10551 x_draw_glyph_string,
10552 x_define_frame_cursor,
10553 x_clear_frame_area,
10554 x_draw_window_cursor,
10555 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10556 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10557 };
10558
10559
10560 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10561 void
10562 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10563 {
10564 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10565
10566 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10567 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10568 if (!terminal->name)
10569 return;
10570
10571 block_input ();
10572 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10573 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10574 X display. */
10575 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10576 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10577 #endif
10578
10579 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10580 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10581 if (dpyinfo->display)
10582 {
10583 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10584 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10585
10586 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10587 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10588 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10589 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10590
10591 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10592 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10593 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10594 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10595 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10596 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10597 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10598 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10599 leaks in other situations. */
10600 #if 0
10601 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10602 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10603 #else
10604 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10605 #endif
10606 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10607 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10608 closing all the displays. */
10609 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10610 #endif
10611
10612 #ifdef USE_GTK
10613 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10614 #else
10615 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10616 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10617 #else
10618 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10619 #endif
10620 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10621 }
10622
10623 /* Mark as dead. */
10624 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10625 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10626 unblock_input ();
10627 }
10628
10629 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10630 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10631
10632 static struct terminal *
10633 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10634 {
10635 struct terminal *terminal;
10636
10637 terminal = create_terminal ();
10638
10639 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10640 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10641 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10642
10643 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10644
10645 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10646 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10647 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10648 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10649 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10650 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10651 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10652 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10653 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10654 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10655 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10656 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10657 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10658 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10659 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10660 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10661 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10662 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10663 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10664 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10665
10666 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10667 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10668
10669 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10670 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10671 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10672 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10673 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10674 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10675 off the bottom. */
10676
10677 return terminal;
10678 }
10679
10680 void
10681 x_initialize (void)
10682 {
10683 baud_rate = 19200;
10684
10685 x_noop_count = 0;
10686 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10687 any_help_event_p = 0;
10688 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10689
10690 #ifdef USE_GTK
10691 current_count = -1;
10692 #endif
10693
10694 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10695 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10696
10697 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10698 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10699
10700 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10701
10702 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10703 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10704 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10705 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10706 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10707 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10708 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10709
10710 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10711 #endif
10712
10713 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10714 #ifndef USE_GTK
10715 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10716 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10717 #endif
10718 #endif
10719
10720 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10721 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10722 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10723
10724 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10725 original error handler. */
10726 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10727 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10728 }
10729
10730
10731 void
10732 syms_of_xterm (void)
10733 {
10734 x_error_message = NULL;
10735
10736 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10737 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10738
10739 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10740 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10741
10742 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
10743 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1, "latin-1");
10744
10745 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10746 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10747
10748 #ifdef USE_GTK
10749 xg_default_icon_file = build_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10750 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10751
10752 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock, "x-gtk-map-stock");
10753 #endif
10754
10755 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10756 x_use_underline_position_properties,
10757 doc: /* Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10758 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10759 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10760 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10761 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10762 sizes. */);
10763 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10764
10765 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10766 x_underline_at_descent_line,
10767 doc: /* Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10768 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10769 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10770 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10771 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10772
10773 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10774 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10775 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10776 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10777 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10778 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10779 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10780 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10781 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10782
10783 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10784 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10785 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10786 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10787 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10788 With MS Windows or Nextstep, the value is t. */);
10789 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10790 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10791 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10792 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10793 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10794 #elif USE_GTK
10795 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10796 #else
10797 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10798 #endif
10799 #else
10800 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10801 #endif
10802
10803 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10804 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10805
10806 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10807 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10808 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10809 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10810 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10811 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10812 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10813 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10814 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10815
10816 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
10817 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10818 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10819 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10820 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10821 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10822
10823 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
10824 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10825 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10826 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10827 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10828 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10829
10830 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
10831 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10832 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10833 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10834 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10835 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10836
10837 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
10838 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10839 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10840 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10841 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10842 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10843
10844 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
10845 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10846 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (hashtest_eql, make_number (900),
10847 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10848 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10849 Qnil);
10850 }
10851
10852 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */